1 //===---- TargetInfo.cpp - Encapsulate target details -----------*- C++ -*-===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // These classes wrap the information about a call or function
10 // definition used to handle ABI compliancy.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "TargetInfo.h"
15 #include "ABIInfo.h"
16 #include "CGBlocks.h"
17 #include "CGCXXABI.h"
18 #include "CGValue.h"
19 #include "CodeGenFunction.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/CodeGenOptions.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticFrontend.h"
24 #include "clang/CodeGen/CGFunctionInfo.h"
25 #include "clang/CodeGen/SwiftCallingConv.h"
26 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallBitVector.h"
27 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
28 #include "llvm/ADT/StringSwitch.h"
29 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
30 #include "llvm/ADT/Twine.h"
31 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
32 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsNVPTX.h"
33 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
34 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
35 #include <algorithm> // std::sort
36 
37 using namespace clang;
38 using namespace CodeGen;
39 
40 // Helper for coercing an aggregate argument or return value into an integer
41 // array of the same size (including padding) and alignment.  This alternate
42 // coercion happens only for the RenderScript ABI and can be removed after
43 // runtimes that rely on it are no longer supported.
44 //
45 // RenderScript assumes that the size of the argument / return value in the IR
46 // is the same as the size of the corresponding qualified type. This helper
47 // coerces the aggregate type into an array of the same size (including
48 // padding).  This coercion is used in lieu of expansion of struct members or
49 // other canonical coercions that return a coerced-type of larger size.
50 //
51 // Ty          - The argument / return value type
52 // Context     - The associated ASTContext
53 // LLVMContext - The associated LLVMContext
54 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArray(QualType Ty,
55                                    ASTContext &Context,
56                                    llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext) {
57   // Alignment and Size are measured in bits.
58   const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
59   const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
60   llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Alignment);
61   const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Alignment - 1) / Alignment;
62   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements));
63 }
64 
65 static void AssignToArrayRange(CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder,
66                                llvm::Value *Array,
67                                llvm::Value *Value,
68                                unsigned FirstIndex,
69                                unsigned LastIndex) {
70   // Alternatively, we could emit this as a loop in the source.
71   for (unsigned I = FirstIndex; I <= LastIndex; ++I) {
72     llvm::Value *Cell =
73         Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(Builder.getInt8Ty(), Array, I);
74     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(Value, Cell, CharUnits::One());
75   }
76 }
77 
78 static bool isAggregateTypeForABI(QualType T) {
79   return !CodeGenFunction::hasScalarEvaluationKind(T) ||
80          T->isMemberFunctionPointerType();
81 }
82 
83 ABIArgInfo ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirect(QualType Ty, bool ByVal,
84                                             bool Realign,
85                                             llvm::Type *Padding) const {
86   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty), ByVal,
87                                  Realign, Padding);
88 }
89 
90 ABIArgInfo
91 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(QualType Ty, bool Realign) const {
92   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectInReg(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty),
93                                       /*ByVal*/ false, Realign);
94 }
95 
96 Address ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
97                              QualType Ty) const {
98   return Address::invalid();
99 }
100 
101 bool ABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const {
102   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType())
103     return true;
104 
105   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
106     if (EIT->getNumBits() < getContext().getTypeSize(getContext().IntTy))
107       return true;
108 
109   return false;
110 }
111 
112 ABIInfo::~ABIInfo() {}
113 
114 /// Does the given lowering require more than the given number of
115 /// registers when expanded?
116 ///
117 /// This is intended to be the basis of a reasonable basic implementation
118 /// of should{Pass,Return}IndirectlyForSwift.
119 ///
120 /// For most targets, a limit of four total registers is reasonable; this
121 /// limits the amount of code required in order to move around the value
122 /// in case it wasn't produced immediately prior to the call by the caller
123 /// (or wasn't produced in exactly the right registers) or isn't used
124 /// immediately within the callee.  But some targets may need to further
125 /// limit the register count due to an inability to support that many
126 /// return registers.
127 static bool occupiesMoreThan(CodeGenTypes &cgt,
128                              ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalarTypes,
129                              unsigned maxAllRegisters) {
130   unsigned intCount = 0, fpCount = 0;
131   for (llvm::Type *type : scalarTypes) {
132     if (type->isPointerTy()) {
133       intCount++;
134     } else if (auto intTy = dyn_cast<llvm::IntegerType>(type)) {
135       auto ptrWidth = cgt.getTarget().getPointerWidth(0);
136       intCount += (intTy->getBitWidth() + ptrWidth - 1) / ptrWidth;
137     } else {
138       assert(type->isVectorTy() || type->isFloatingPointTy());
139       fpCount++;
140     }
141   }
142 
143   return (intCount + fpCount > maxAllRegisters);
144 }
145 
146 bool SwiftABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize,
147                                              llvm::Type *eltTy,
148                                              unsigned numElts) const {
149   // The default implementation of this assumes that the target guarantees
150   // 128-bit SIMD support but nothing more.
151   return (vectorSize.getQuantity() > 8 && vectorSize.getQuantity() <= 16);
152 }
153 
154 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(const RecordType *RT,
155                                               CGCXXABI &CXXABI) {
156   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
157   if (!RD) {
158     if (!RT->getDecl()->canPassInRegisters())
159       return CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect;
160     return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default;
161   }
162   return CXXABI.getRecordArgABI(RD);
163 }
164 
165 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(QualType T,
166                                               CGCXXABI &CXXABI) {
167   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
168   if (!RT)
169     return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default;
170   return getRecordArgABI(RT, CXXABI);
171 }
172 
173 static bool classifyReturnType(const CGCXXABI &CXXABI, CGFunctionInfo &FI,
174                                const ABIInfo &Info) {
175   QualType Ty = FI.getReturnType();
176 
177   if (const auto *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>())
178     if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()) &&
179         !RT->getDecl()->canPassInRegisters()) {
180       FI.getReturnInfo() = Info.getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
181       return true;
182     }
183 
184   return CXXABI.classifyReturnType(FI);
185 }
186 
187 /// Pass transparent unions as if they were the type of the first element. Sema
188 /// should ensure that all elements of the union have the same "machine type".
189 static QualType useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(QualType Ty) {
190   if (const RecordType *UT = Ty->getAsUnionType()) {
191     const RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
192     if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
193       assert(!UD->field_empty() && "sema created an empty transparent union");
194       return UD->field_begin()->getType();
195     }
196   }
197   return Ty;
198 }
199 
200 CGCXXABI &ABIInfo::getCXXABI() const {
201   return CGT.getCXXABI();
202 }
203 
204 ASTContext &ABIInfo::getContext() const {
205   return CGT.getContext();
206 }
207 
208 llvm::LLVMContext &ABIInfo::getVMContext() const {
209   return CGT.getLLVMContext();
210 }
211 
212 const llvm::DataLayout &ABIInfo::getDataLayout() const {
213   return CGT.getDataLayout();
214 }
215 
216 const TargetInfo &ABIInfo::getTarget() const {
217   return CGT.getTarget();
218 }
219 
220 const CodeGenOptions &ABIInfo::getCodeGenOpts() const {
221   return CGT.getCodeGenOpts();
222 }
223 
224 bool ABIInfo::isAndroid() const { return getTarget().getTriple().isAndroid(); }
225 
226 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
227   return false;
228 }
229 
230 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
231                                                 uint64_t Members) const {
232   return false;
233 }
234 
235 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ABIArgInfo::dump() const {
236   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
237   OS << "(ABIArgInfo Kind=";
238   switch (TheKind) {
239   case Direct:
240     OS << "Direct Type=";
241     if (llvm::Type *Ty = getCoerceToType())
242       Ty->print(OS);
243     else
244       OS << "null";
245     break;
246   case Extend:
247     OS << "Extend";
248     break;
249   case Ignore:
250     OS << "Ignore";
251     break;
252   case InAlloca:
253     OS << "InAlloca Offset=" << getInAllocaFieldIndex();
254     break;
255   case Indirect:
256     OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity()
257        << " ByVal=" << getIndirectByVal()
258        << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign();
259     break;
260   case IndirectAliased:
261     OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity()
262        << " AadrSpace=" << getIndirectAddrSpace()
263        << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign();
264     break;
265   case Expand:
266     OS << "Expand";
267     break;
268   case CoerceAndExpand:
269     OS << "CoerceAndExpand Type=";
270     getCoerceAndExpandType()->print(OS);
271     break;
272   }
273   OS << ")\n";
274 }
275 
276 // Dynamically round a pointer up to a multiple of the given alignment.
277 static llvm::Value *emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
278                                                   llvm::Value *Ptr,
279                                                   CharUnits Align) {
280   llvm::Value *PtrAsInt = Ptr;
281   // OverflowArgArea = (OverflowArgArea + Align - 1) & -Align;
282   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(PtrAsInt, CGF.IntPtrTy);
283   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(PtrAsInt,
284         llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, Align.getQuantity() - 1));
285   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(PtrAsInt,
286            llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, -Align.getQuantity()));
287   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(PtrAsInt,
288                                         Ptr->getType(),
289                                         Ptr->getName() + ".aligned");
290   return PtrAsInt;
291 }
292 
293 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation,
294 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack.
295 ///
296 /// This version implements the core direct-value passing rules.
297 ///
298 /// \param SlotSize - The size and alignment of a stack slot.
299 ///   Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of
300 ///   slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value.
301 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap;
302 ///   an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size
303 ///   will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially
304 ///   leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding.  If this
305 ///   is false, the returned address might be less-aligned than
306 ///   DirectAlign.
307 static Address emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
308                                       Address VAListAddr,
309                                       llvm::Type *DirectTy,
310                                       CharUnits DirectSize,
311                                       CharUnits DirectAlign,
312                                       CharUnits SlotSize,
313                                       bool AllowHigherAlign) {
314   // Cast the element type to i8* if necessary.  Some platforms define
315   // va_list as a struct containing an i8* instead of just an i8*.
316   if (VAListAddr.getElementType() != CGF.Int8PtrTy)
317     VAListAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(VAListAddr, CGF.Int8PtrTy);
318 
319   llvm::Value *Ptr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "argp.cur");
320 
321   // If the CC aligns values higher than the slot size, do so if needed.
322   Address Addr = Address::invalid();
323   if (AllowHigherAlign && DirectAlign > SlotSize) {
324     Addr = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, DirectAlign),
325                                                  DirectAlign);
326   } else {
327     Addr = Address(Ptr, SlotSize);
328   }
329 
330   // Advance the pointer past the argument, then store that back.
331   CharUnits FullDirectSize = DirectSize.alignTo(SlotSize);
332   Address NextPtr =
333       CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, FullDirectSize, "argp.next");
334   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr.getPointer(), VAListAddr);
335 
336   // If the argument is smaller than a slot, and this is a big-endian
337   // target, the argument will be right-adjusted in its slot.
338   if (DirectSize < SlotSize && CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() &&
339       !DirectTy->isStructTy()) {
340     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, SlotSize - DirectSize);
341   }
342 
343   Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, DirectTy);
344   return Addr;
345 }
346 
347 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation,
348 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack.
349 ///
350 /// \param IsIndirect - Values of this type are passed indirectly.
351 /// \param ValueInfo - The size and alignment of this type, generally
352 ///   computed with getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(ValueTy).
353 /// \param SlotSizeAndAlign - The size and alignment of a stack slot.
354 ///   Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of
355 ///   slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value.
356 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap;
357 ///   an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size
358 ///   will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially
359 ///   leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding.
360 static Address emitVoidPtrVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
361                                 QualType ValueTy, bool IsIndirect,
362                                 TypeInfoChars ValueInfo,
363                                 CharUnits SlotSizeAndAlign,
364                                 bool AllowHigherAlign) {
365   // The size and alignment of the value that was passed directly.
366   CharUnits DirectSize, DirectAlign;
367   if (IsIndirect) {
368     DirectSize = CGF.getPointerSize();
369     DirectAlign = CGF.getPointerAlign();
370   } else {
371     DirectSize = ValueInfo.Width;
372     DirectAlign = ValueInfo.Align;
373   }
374 
375   // Cast the address we've calculated to the right type.
376   llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(ValueTy);
377   if (IsIndirect)
378     DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0);
379 
380   Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, DirectTy,
381                                         DirectSize, DirectAlign,
382                                         SlotSizeAndAlign,
383                                         AllowHigherAlign);
384 
385   if (IsIndirect) {
386     Addr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr), ValueInfo.Align);
387   }
388 
389   return Addr;
390 
391 }
392 
393 static Address emitMergePHI(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
394                             Address Addr1, llvm::BasicBlock *Block1,
395                             Address Addr2, llvm::BasicBlock *Block2,
396                             const llvm::Twine &Name = "") {
397   assert(Addr1.getType() == Addr2.getType());
398   llvm::PHINode *PHI = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(Addr1.getType(), 2, Name);
399   PHI->addIncoming(Addr1.getPointer(), Block1);
400   PHI->addIncoming(Addr2.getPointer(), Block2);
401   CharUnits Align = std::min(Addr1.getAlignment(), Addr2.getAlignment());
402   return Address(PHI, Align);
403 }
404 
405 TargetCodeGenInfo::~TargetCodeGenInfo() = default;
406 
407 // If someone can figure out a general rule for this, that would be great.
408 // It's probably just doomed to be platform-dependent, though.
409 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException() const {
410   // Verified for:
411   //   x86-64     FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin
412   //   x86-32     FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin
413   //   PowerPC    Linux, Darwin
414   //   ARM        Darwin (*not* EABI)
415   //   AArch64    Linux
416   return 32;
417 }
418 
419 bool TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args,
420                                      const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const {
421   // The following conventions are known to require this to be false:
422   //   x86_stdcall
423   //   MIPS
424   // For everything else, we just prefer false unless we opt out.
425   return false;
426 }
427 
428 void
429 TargetCodeGenInfo::getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
430                                              llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const {
431   // This assumes the user is passing a library name like "rt" instead of a
432   // filename like "librt.a/so", and that they don't care whether it's static or
433   // dynamic.
434   Opt = "-l";
435   Opt += Lib;
436 }
437 
438 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
439   // OpenCL kernels are called via an explicit runtime API with arguments
440   // set with clSetKernelArg(), not as normal sub-functions.
441   // Return SPIR_KERNEL by default as the kernel calling convention to
442   // ensure the fingerprint is fixed such way that each OpenCL argument
443   // gets one matching argument in the produced kernel function argument
444   // list to enable feasible implementation of clSetKernelArg() with
445   // aggregates etc. In case we would use the default C calling conv here,
446   // clSetKernelArg() might break depending on the target-specific
447   // conventions; different targets might split structs passed as values
448   // to multiple function arguments etc.
449   return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL;
450 }
451 
452 llvm::Constant *TargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
453     llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const {
454   return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(T);
455 }
456 
457 LangAS TargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
458                                                    const VarDecl *D) const {
459   assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
460          !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) &&
461          "Address space agnostic languages only");
462   return D ? D->getType().getAddressSpace() : LangAS::Default;
463 }
464 
465 llvm::Value *TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(
466     CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Value *Src, LangAS SrcAddr,
467     LangAS DestAddr, llvm::Type *DestTy, bool isNonNull) const {
468   // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address
469   // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast.
470   if (auto *C = dyn_cast<llvm::Constant>(Src))
471     return performAddrSpaceCast(CGF.CGM, C, SrcAddr, DestAddr, DestTy);
472   // Try to preserve the source's name to make IR more readable.
473   return CGF.Builder.CreatePointerBitCastOrAddrSpaceCast(
474       Src, DestTy, Src->hasName() ? Src->getName() + ".ascast" : "");
475 }
476 
477 llvm::Constant *
478 TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::Constant *Src,
479                                         LangAS SrcAddr, LangAS DestAddr,
480                                         llvm::Type *DestTy) const {
481   // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address
482   // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast.
483   return llvm::ConstantExpr::getPointerCast(Src, DestTy);
484 }
485 
486 llvm::SyncScope::ID
487 TargetCodeGenInfo::getLLVMSyncScopeID(const LangOptions &LangOpts,
488                                       SyncScope Scope,
489                                       llvm::AtomicOrdering Ordering,
490                                       llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx) const {
491   return Ctx.getOrInsertSyncScopeID(""); /* default sync scope */
492 }
493 
494 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays);
495 
496 /// isEmptyField - Return true iff a the field is "empty", that is it
497 /// is an unnamed bit-field or an (array of) empty record(s).
498 static bool isEmptyField(ASTContext &Context, const FieldDecl *FD,
499                          bool AllowArrays) {
500   if (FD->isUnnamedBitfield())
501     return true;
502 
503   QualType FT = FD->getType();
504 
505   // Constant arrays of empty records count as empty, strip them off.
506   // Constant arrays of zero length always count as empty.
507   bool WasArray = false;
508   if (AllowArrays)
509     while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
510       if (AT->getSize() == 0)
511         return true;
512       FT = AT->getElementType();
513       // The [[no_unique_address]] special case below does not apply to
514       // arrays of C++ empty records, so we need to remember this fact.
515       WasArray = true;
516     }
517 
518   const RecordType *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>();
519   if (!RT)
520     return false;
521 
522   // C++ record fields are never empty, at least in the Itanium ABI.
523   //
524   // FIXME: We should use a predicate for whether this behavior is true in the
525   // current ABI.
526   //
527   // The exception to the above rule are fields marked with the
528   // [[no_unique_address]] attribute (since C++20).  Those do count as empty
529   // according to the Itanium ABI.  The exception applies only to records,
530   // not arrays of records, so we must also check whether we stripped off an
531   // array type above.
532   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()) &&
533       (WasArray || !FD->hasAttr<NoUniqueAddressAttr>()))
534     return false;
535 
536   return isEmptyRecord(Context, FT, AllowArrays);
537 }
538 
539 /// isEmptyRecord - Return true iff a structure contains only empty
540 /// fields. Note that a structure with a flexible array member is not
541 /// considered empty.
542 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays) {
543   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
544   if (!RT)
545     return false;
546   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
547   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
548     return false;
549 
550   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
551   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
552     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
553       if (!isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true))
554         return false;
555 
556   for (const auto *I : RD->fields())
557     if (!isEmptyField(Context, I, AllowArrays))
558       return false;
559   return true;
560 }
561 
562 /// isSingleElementStruct - Determine if a structure is a "single
563 /// element struct", i.e. it has exactly one non-empty field or
564 /// exactly one field which is itself a single element
565 /// struct. Structures with flexible array members are never
566 /// considered single element structs.
567 ///
568 /// \return The field declaration for the single non-empty field, if
569 /// it exists.
570 static const Type *isSingleElementStruct(QualType T, ASTContext &Context) {
571   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
572   if (!RT)
573     return nullptr;
574 
575   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
576   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
577     return nullptr;
578 
579   const Type *Found = nullptr;
580 
581   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
582   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
583     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
584       // Ignore empty records.
585       if (isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true))
586         continue;
587 
588       // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element struct.
589       if (Found)
590         return nullptr;
591 
592       // If this is non-empty and not a single element struct, the composite
593       // cannot be a single element struct.
594       Found = isSingleElementStruct(I.getType(), Context);
595       if (!Found)
596         return nullptr;
597     }
598   }
599 
600   // Check for single element.
601   for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
602     QualType FT = FD->getType();
603 
604     // Ignore empty fields.
605     if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true))
606       continue;
607 
608     // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element
609     // struct.
610     if (Found)
611       return nullptr;
612 
613     // Treat single element arrays as the element.
614     while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
615       if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() != 1)
616         break;
617       FT = AT->getElementType();
618     }
619 
620     if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(FT)) {
621       Found = FT.getTypePtr();
622     } else {
623       Found = isSingleElementStruct(FT, Context);
624       if (!Found)
625         return nullptr;
626     }
627   }
628 
629   // We don't consider a struct a single-element struct if it has
630   // padding beyond the element type.
631   if (Found && Context.getTypeSize(Found) != Context.getTypeSize(T))
632     return nullptr;
633 
634   return Found;
635 }
636 
637 namespace {
638 Address EmitVAArgInstr(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
639                        const ABIArgInfo &AI) {
640   // This default implementation defers to the llvm backend's va_arg
641   // instruction. It can handle only passing arguments directly
642   // (typically only handled in the backend for primitive types), or
643   // aggregates passed indirectly by pointer (NOTE: if the "byval"
644   // flag has ABI impact in the callee, this implementation cannot
645   // work.)
646 
647   // Only a few cases are covered here at the moment -- those needed
648   // by the default abi.
649   llvm::Value *Val;
650 
651   if (AI.isIndirect()) {
652     assert(!AI.getPaddingType() &&
653            "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
654     assert(
655         !AI.getIndirectRealign() &&
656         "Unexpected IndirectRealign seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
657 
658     auto TyInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
659     CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.Align;
660 
661     llvm::Type *BaseTy =
662         llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
663     llvm::Value *Addr =
664         CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), BaseTy);
665     return Address(Addr, TyAlignForABI);
666   } else {
667     assert((AI.isDirect() || AI.isExtend()) &&
668            "Unexpected ArgInfo Kind in generic VAArg emitter!");
669 
670     assert(!AI.getInReg() &&
671            "Unexpected InReg seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
672     assert(!AI.getPaddingType() &&
673            "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
674     assert(!AI.getDirectOffset() &&
675            "Unexpected DirectOffset seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
676     assert(!AI.getCoerceToType() &&
677            "Unexpected CoerceToType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
678 
679     Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "varet");
680     Val = CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), CGF.ConvertType(Ty));
681     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Val, Temp);
682     return Temp;
683   }
684 }
685 
686 /// DefaultABIInfo - The default implementation for ABI specific
687 /// details. This implementation provides information which results in
688 /// self-consistent and sensible LLVM IR generation, but does not
689 /// conform to any particular ABI.
690 class DefaultABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
691 public:
692   DefaultABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
693 
694   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
695   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
696 
697   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
698     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
699       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
700     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
701       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
702   }
703 
704   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
705                     QualType Ty) const override {
706     return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty));
707   }
708 };
709 
710 class DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
711 public:
712   DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
713       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<DefaultABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
714 };
715 
716 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
717   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
718 
719   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
720     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
721     // passed by value.
722     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
723       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
724 
725     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
726   }
727 
728   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
729   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
730     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
731 
732   ASTContext &Context = getContext();
733   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
734     if (EIT->getNumBits() >
735         Context.getTypeSize(Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()
736                                 ? Context.Int128Ty
737                                 : Context.LongLongTy))
738       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
739 
740   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
741                                             : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
742 }
743 
744 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
745   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
746     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
747 
748   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy))
749     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
750 
751   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
752   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
753     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
754 
755   if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
756     if (EIT->getNumBits() >
757         getContext().getTypeSize(getContext().getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()
758                                      ? getContext().Int128Ty
759                                      : getContext().LongLongTy))
760       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
761 
762   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
763                                                : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
764 }
765 
766 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
767 // WebAssembly ABI Implementation
768 //
769 // This is a very simple ABI that relies a lot on DefaultABIInfo.
770 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
771 
772 class WebAssemblyABIInfo final : public SwiftABIInfo {
773 public:
774   enum ABIKind {
775     MVP = 0,
776     ExperimentalMV = 1,
777   };
778 
779 private:
780   DefaultABIInfo defaultInfo;
781   ABIKind Kind;
782 
783 public:
784   explicit WebAssemblyABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind)
785       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), defaultInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {}
786 
787 private:
788   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
789   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
790 
791   // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are
792   // non-virtual, but computeInfo and EmitVAArg are virtual, so we
793   // overload them.
794   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
795     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
796       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
797     for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
798       Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
799   }
800 
801   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
802                     QualType Ty) const override;
803 
804   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
805                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
806     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
807   }
808 
809   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
810     return false;
811   }
812 };
813 
814 class WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo final : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
815 public:
816   explicit WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT,
817                                         WebAssemblyABIInfo::ABIKind K)
818       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<WebAssemblyABIInfo>(CGT, K)) {}
819 
820   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
821                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
822     TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
823     if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
824       if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>()) {
825         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
826         llvm::AttrBuilder B;
827         B.addAttribute("wasm-import-module", Attr->getImportModule());
828         Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
829       }
830       if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>()) {
831         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
832         llvm::AttrBuilder B;
833         B.addAttribute("wasm-import-name", Attr->getImportName());
834         Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
835       }
836       if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<WebAssemblyExportNameAttr>()) {
837         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
838         llvm::AttrBuilder B;
839         B.addAttribute("wasm-export-name", Attr->getExportName());
840         Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
841       }
842     }
843 
844     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
845       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
846       if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() && !FD->hasPrototype())
847         Fn->addFnAttr("no-prototype");
848     }
849   }
850 };
851 
852 /// Classify argument of given type \p Ty.
853 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
854   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
855 
856   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
857     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
858     // passed by value.
859     if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
860       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
861     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
862     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
863       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
864     // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We
865     // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(),
866     // though watch out for things like bitfields.
867     if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
868       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
869     // For the experimental multivalue ABI, fully expand all other aggregates
870     if (Kind == ABIKind::ExperimentalMV) {
871       const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
872       assert(RT);
873       bool HasBitField = false;
874       for (auto *Field : RT->getDecl()->fields()) {
875         if (Field->isBitField()) {
876           HasBitField = true;
877           break;
878         }
879       }
880       if (!HasBitField)
881         return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
882     }
883   }
884 
885   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
886   return defaultInfo.classifyArgumentType(Ty);
887 }
888 
889 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
890   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
891     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
892     // returned by value.
893     if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) {
894       // Ignore empty structs/unions.
895       if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
896         return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
897       // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. TODO: We
898       // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using
899       // ABIArgInfo::getDirect().
900       if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext()))
901         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
902       // For the experimental multivalue ABI, return all other aggregates
903       if (Kind == ABIKind::ExperimentalMV)
904         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
905     }
906   }
907 
908   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
909   return defaultInfo.classifyReturnType(RetTy);
910 }
911 
912 Address WebAssemblyABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
913                                       QualType Ty) const {
914   bool IsIndirect = isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) &&
915                     !isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true) &&
916                     !isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext());
917   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect,
918                           getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
919                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
920                           /*AllowHigherAlign=*/true);
921 }
922 
923 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
924 // le32/PNaCl bitcode ABI Implementation
925 //
926 // This is a simplified version of the x86_32 ABI.  Arguments and return values
927 // are always passed on the stack.
928 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
929 
930 class PNaClABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
931  public:
932   PNaClABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
933 
934   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
935   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
936 
937   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
938   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
939                     Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const override;
940 };
941 
942 class PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
943  public:
944    PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
945        : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<PNaClABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
946 };
947 
948 void PNaClABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
949   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
950     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
951 
952   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
953     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
954 }
955 
956 Address PNaClABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
957                                 QualType Ty) const {
958   // The PNaCL ABI is a bit odd, in that varargs don't use normal
959   // function classification. Structs get passed directly for varargs
960   // functions, through a rewriting transform in
961   // pnacl-llvm/lib/Transforms/NaCl/ExpandVarArgs.cpp, which allows
962   // this target to actually support a va_arg instructions with an
963   // aggregate type, unlike other targets.
964   return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
965 }
966 
967 /// Classify argument of given type \p Ty.
968 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
969   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
970     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
971       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
972     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
973   } else if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
974     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
975     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
976   } else if (Ty->isFloatingType()) {
977     // Floating-point types don't go inreg.
978     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
979   } else if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
980     // Treat extended integers as integers if <=64, otherwise pass indirectly.
981     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
982       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
983     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
984   }
985 
986   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
987                                             : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
988 }
989 
990 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
991   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
992     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
993 
994   // In the PNaCl ABI we always return records/structures on the stack.
995   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy))
996     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
997 
998   // Treat extended integers as integers if <=64, otherwise pass indirectly.
999   if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
1000     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
1001       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
1002     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1003   }
1004 
1005   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
1006   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
1007     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1008 
1009   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
1010                                                : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
1011 }
1012 
1013 /// IsX86_MMXType - Return true if this is an MMX type.
1014 bool IsX86_MMXType(llvm::Type *IRType) {
1015   // Return true if the type is an MMX type <2 x i32>, <4 x i16>, or <8 x i8>.
1016   return IRType->isVectorTy() && IRType->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == 64 &&
1017     cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() &&
1018     IRType->getScalarSizeInBits() != 64;
1019 }
1020 
1021 static llvm::Type* X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1022                                           StringRef Constraint,
1023                                           llvm::Type* Ty) {
1024   bool IsMMXCons = llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(Constraint)
1025                      .Cases("y", "&y", "^Ym", true)
1026                      .Default(false);
1027   if (IsMMXCons && Ty->isVectorTy()) {
1028     if (cast<llvm::VectorType>(Ty)->getPrimitiveSizeInBits().getFixedSize() !=
1029         64) {
1030       // Invalid MMX constraint
1031       return nullptr;
1032     }
1033 
1034     return llvm::Type::getX86_MMXTy(CGF.getLLVMContext());
1035   }
1036 
1037   // No operation needed
1038   return Ty;
1039 }
1040 
1041 /// Returns true if this type can be passed in SSE registers with the
1042 /// X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64.
1043 static bool isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
1044   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1045     if (BT->isFloatingPoint() && BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Half) {
1046       if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) {
1047         if (&Context.getTargetInfo().getLongDoubleFormat() ==
1048             &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended())
1049           return false;
1050       }
1051       return true;
1052     }
1053   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
1054     // vectorcall can pass XMM, YMM, and ZMM vectors. We don't pass SSE1 MMX
1055     // registers specially.
1056     unsigned VecSize = Context.getTypeSize(VT);
1057     if (VecSize == 128 || VecSize == 256 || VecSize == 512)
1058       return true;
1059   }
1060   return false;
1061 }
1062 
1063 /// Returns true if this aggregate is small enough to be passed in SSE registers
1064 /// in the X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64.
1065 static bool isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(uint64_t NumMembers) {
1066   return NumMembers <= 4;
1067 }
1068 
1069 /// Returns a Homogeneous Vector Aggregate ABIArgInfo, used in X86.
1070 static ABIArgInfo getDirectX86Hva(llvm::Type* T = nullptr) {
1071   auto AI = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(T);
1072   AI.setInReg(true);
1073   AI.setCanBeFlattened(false);
1074   return AI;
1075 }
1076 
1077 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1078 // X86-32 ABI Implementation
1079 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1080 
1081 /// Similar to llvm::CCState, but for Clang.
1082 struct CCState {
1083   CCState(CGFunctionInfo &FI)
1084       : IsPreassigned(FI.arg_size()), CC(FI.getCallingConvention()) {}
1085 
1086   llvm::SmallBitVector IsPreassigned;
1087   unsigned CC = CallingConv::CC_C;
1088   unsigned FreeRegs = 0;
1089   unsigned FreeSSERegs = 0;
1090 };
1091 
1092 enum {
1093   // Vectorcall only allows the first 6 parameters to be passed in registers.
1094   VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg = 6
1095 };
1096 
1097 /// X86_32ABIInfo - The X86-32 ABI information.
1098 class X86_32ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
1099   enum Class {
1100     Integer,
1101     Float
1102   };
1103 
1104   static const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4;
1105 
1106   bool IsDarwinVectorABI;
1107   bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI;
1108   bool IsWin32StructABI;
1109   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
1110   bool IsMCUABI;
1111   unsigned DefaultNumRegisterParameters;
1112 
1113   static bool isRegisterSize(unsigned Size) {
1114     return (Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32 || Size == 64);
1115   }
1116 
1117   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override {
1118     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
1119     return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty);
1120   }
1121 
1122   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
1123                                          uint64_t NumMembers) const override {
1124     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
1125     return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers);
1126   }
1127 
1128   bool shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) const;
1129 
1130   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
1131   /// such that the argument will be passed in memory.
1132   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const;
1133 
1134   ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
1135 
1136   /// Return the alignment to use for the given type on the stack.
1137   unsigned getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, unsigned Align) const;
1138 
1139   Class classify(QualType Ty) const;
1140   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
1141   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
1142 
1143   /// Updates the number of available free registers, returns
1144   /// true if any registers were allocated.
1145   bool updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
1146 
1147   bool shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, bool &InReg,
1148                                 bool &NeedsPadding) const;
1149   bool shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
1150 
1151   bool canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const;
1152 
1153   /// Rewrite the function info so that all memory arguments use
1154   /// inalloca.
1155   void rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const;
1156 
1157   void addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields,
1158                            CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info,
1159                            QualType Type) const;
1160   void runVectorCallFirstPass(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State) const;
1161 
1162 public:
1163 
1164   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
1165   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
1166                     QualType Ty) const override;
1167 
1168   X86_32ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI,
1169                 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
1170                 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI)
1171     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), IsDarwinVectorABI(DarwinVectorABI),
1172       IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI),
1173       IsWin32StructABI(Win32StructABI),
1174       IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI),
1175       IsMCUABI(CGT.getTarget().getTriple().isOSIAMCU()),
1176       DefaultNumRegisterParameters(NumRegisterParameters) {}
1177 
1178   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
1179                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
1180     // LLVM's x86-32 lowering currently only assigns up to three
1181     // integer registers and three fp registers.  Oddly, it'll use up to
1182     // four vector registers for vectors, but those can overlap with the
1183     // scalar registers.
1184     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 3);
1185   }
1186 
1187   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
1188     // x86-32 lowering does not support passing swifterror in a register.
1189     return false;
1190   }
1191 };
1192 
1193 class X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
1194 public:
1195   X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI,
1196                           bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
1197                           unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI)
1198       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<X86_32ABIInfo>(
1199             CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, Win32StructABI,
1200             NumRegisterParameters, SoftFloatABI)) {}
1201 
1202   static bool isStructReturnInRegABI(
1203       const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts);
1204 
1205   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
1206                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
1207 
1208   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
1209     // Darwin uses different dwarf register numbers for EH.
1210     if (CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) return 5;
1211     return 4;
1212   }
1213 
1214   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1215                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
1216 
1217   llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1218                                   StringRef Constraint,
1219                                   llvm::Type* Ty) const override {
1220     return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty);
1221   }
1222 
1223   void addReturnRegisterOutputs(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnValue,
1224                                 std::string &Constraints,
1225                                 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes,
1226                                 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes,
1227                                 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests,
1228                                 std::string &AsmString,
1229                                 unsigned NumOutputs) const override;
1230 
1231   llvm::Constant *
1232   getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
1233     unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) |  // jmp rel8
1234                    (0x06 << 8) |  //           .+0x08
1235                    ('v' << 16) |
1236                    ('2' << 24);
1237     return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig);
1238   }
1239 
1240   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
1241     return "movl\t%ebp, %ebp"
1242            "\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
1243   }
1244 };
1245 
1246 }
1247 
1248 /// Rewrite input constraint references after adding some output constraints.
1249 /// In the case where there is one output and one input and we add one output,
1250 /// we need to replace all operand references greater than or equal to 1:
1251 ///     mov $0, $1
1252 ///     mov eax, $1
1253 /// The result will be:
1254 ///     mov $0, $2
1255 ///     mov eax, $2
1256 static void rewriteInputConstraintReferences(unsigned FirstIn,
1257                                              unsigned NumNewOuts,
1258                                              std::string &AsmString) {
1259   std::string Buf;
1260   llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Buf);
1261   size_t Pos = 0;
1262   while (Pos < AsmString.size()) {
1263     size_t DollarStart = AsmString.find('$', Pos);
1264     if (DollarStart == std::string::npos)
1265       DollarStart = AsmString.size();
1266     size_t DollarEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of('$', DollarStart);
1267     if (DollarEnd == std::string::npos)
1268       DollarEnd = AsmString.size();
1269     OS << StringRef(&AsmString[Pos], DollarEnd - Pos);
1270     Pos = DollarEnd;
1271     size_t NumDollars = DollarEnd - DollarStart;
1272     if (NumDollars % 2 != 0 && Pos < AsmString.size()) {
1273       // We have an operand reference.
1274       size_t DigitStart = Pos;
1275       if (AsmString[DigitStart] == '{') {
1276         OS << '{';
1277         ++DigitStart;
1278       }
1279       size_t DigitEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of("0123456789", DigitStart);
1280       if (DigitEnd == std::string::npos)
1281         DigitEnd = AsmString.size();
1282       StringRef OperandStr(&AsmString[DigitStart], DigitEnd - DigitStart);
1283       unsigned OperandIndex;
1284       if (!OperandStr.getAsInteger(10, OperandIndex)) {
1285         if (OperandIndex >= FirstIn)
1286           OperandIndex += NumNewOuts;
1287         OS << OperandIndex;
1288       } else {
1289         OS << OperandStr;
1290       }
1291       Pos = DigitEnd;
1292     }
1293   }
1294   AsmString = std::move(OS.str());
1295 }
1296 
1297 /// Add output constraints for EAX:EDX because they are return registers.
1298 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::addReturnRegisterOutputs(
1299     CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnSlot, std::string &Constraints,
1300     std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes,
1301     std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes,
1302     std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, std::string &AsmString,
1303     unsigned NumOutputs) const {
1304   uint64_t RetWidth = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(ReturnSlot.getType());
1305 
1306   // Use the EAX constraint if the width is 32 or smaller and EAX:EDX if it is
1307   // larger.
1308   if (!Constraints.empty())
1309     Constraints += ',';
1310   if (RetWidth <= 32) {
1311     Constraints += "={eax}";
1312     ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int32Ty);
1313   } else {
1314     // Use the 'A' constraint for EAX:EDX.
1315     Constraints += "=A";
1316     ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int64Ty);
1317   }
1318 
1319   // Truncate EAX or EAX:EDX to an integer of the appropriate size.
1320   llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(CGF.getLLVMContext(), RetWidth);
1321   ResultTruncRegTypes.push_back(CoerceTy);
1322 
1323   // Coerce the integer by bitcasting the return slot pointer.
1324   ReturnSlot.setAddress(CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(ReturnSlot.getAddress(CGF),
1325                                                   CoerceTy->getPointerTo()));
1326   ResultRegDests.push_back(ReturnSlot);
1327 
1328   rewriteInputConstraintReferences(NumOutputs, 1, AsmString);
1329 }
1330 
1331 /// shouldReturnTypeInRegister - Determine if the given type should be
1332 /// returned in a register (for the Darwin and MCU ABI).
1333 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty,
1334                                                ASTContext &Context) const {
1335   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
1336 
1337   // For i386, type must be register sized.
1338   // For the MCU ABI, it only needs to be <= 8-byte
1339   if ((IsMCUABI && Size > 64) || (!IsMCUABI && !isRegisterSize(Size)))
1340    return false;
1341 
1342   if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
1343     // 64- and 128- bit vectors inside structures are not returned in
1344     // registers.
1345     if (Size == 64 || Size == 128)
1346       return false;
1347 
1348     return true;
1349   }
1350 
1351   // If this is a builtin, pointer, enum, complex type, member pointer, or
1352   // member function pointer it is ok.
1353   if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() ||
1354       Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isEnumeralType() ||
1355       Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType())
1356     return true;
1357 
1358   // Arrays are treated like records.
1359   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty))
1360     return shouldReturnTypeInRegister(AT->getElementType(), Context);
1361 
1362   // Otherwise, it must be a record type.
1363   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1364   if (!RT) return false;
1365 
1366   // FIXME: Traverse bases here too.
1367 
1368   // Structure types are passed in register if all fields would be
1369   // passed in a register.
1370   for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) {
1371     // Empty fields are ignored.
1372     if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true))
1373       continue;
1374 
1375     // Check fields recursively.
1376     if (!shouldReturnTypeInRegister(FD->getType(), Context))
1377       return false;
1378   }
1379   return true;
1380 }
1381 
1382 static bool is32Or64BitBasicType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) {
1383   // Treat complex types as the element type.
1384   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
1385     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
1386 
1387   // Check for a type which we know has a simple scalar argument-passing
1388   // convention without any padding.  (We're specifically looking for 32
1389   // and 64-bit integer and integer-equivalents, float, and double.)
1390   if (!Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() && !Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() &&
1391       !Ty->isEnumeralType() && !Ty->isBlockPointerType())
1392     return false;
1393 
1394   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
1395   return Size == 32 || Size == 64;
1396 }
1397 
1398 static bool addFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const RecordDecl *RD,
1399                           uint64_t &Size) {
1400   for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
1401     // Scalar arguments on the stack get 4 byte alignment on x86. If the
1402     // argument is smaller than 32-bits, expanding the struct will create
1403     // alignment padding.
1404     if (!is32Or64BitBasicType(FD->getType(), Context))
1405       return false;
1406 
1407     // FIXME: Reject bit-fields wholesale; there are two problems, we don't know
1408     // how to expand them yet, and the predicate for telling if a bitfield still
1409     // counts as "basic" is more complicated than what we were doing previously.
1410     if (FD->isBitField())
1411       return false;
1412 
1413     Size += Context.getTypeSize(FD->getType());
1414   }
1415   return true;
1416 }
1417 
1418 static bool addBaseAndFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const CXXRecordDecl *RD,
1419                                  uint64_t &Size) {
1420   // Don't do this if there are any non-empty bases.
1421   for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base : RD->bases()) {
1422     if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(Context, Base.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(),
1423                               Size))
1424       return false;
1425   }
1426   if (!addFieldSizes(Context, RD, Size))
1427     return false;
1428   return true;
1429 }
1430 
1431 /// Test whether an argument type which is to be passed indirectly (on the
1432 /// stack) would have the equivalent layout if it was expanded into separate
1433 /// arguments. If so, we prefer to do the latter to avoid inhibiting
1434 /// optimizations.
1435 bool X86_32ABIInfo::canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const {
1436   // We can only expand structure types.
1437   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1438   if (!RT)
1439     return false;
1440   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1441   uint64_t Size = 0;
1442   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
1443     if (!IsWin32StructABI) {
1444       // On non-Windows, we have to conservatively match our old bitcode
1445       // prototypes in order to be ABI-compatible at the bitcode level.
1446       if (!CXXRD->isCLike())
1447         return false;
1448     } else {
1449       // Don't do this for dynamic classes.
1450       if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass())
1451         return false;
1452     }
1453     if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(getContext(), CXXRD, Size))
1454       return false;
1455   } else {
1456     if (!addFieldSizes(getContext(), RD, Size))
1457       return false;
1458   }
1459 
1460   // We can do this if there was no alignment padding.
1461   return Size == getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
1462 }
1463 
1464 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const {
1465   // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one
1466   // integer register.
1467   if (State.FreeRegs) {
1468     --State.FreeRegs;
1469     if (!IsMCUABI)
1470       return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(RetTy);
1471   }
1472   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false);
1473 }
1474 
1475 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy,
1476                                              CCState &State) const {
1477   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
1478     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1479 
1480   const Type *Base = nullptr;
1481   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1482   if ((State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1483        State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) &&
1484       isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, NumElts)) {
1485     // The LLVM struct type for such an aggregate should lower properly.
1486     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1487   }
1488 
1489   if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
1490     // On Darwin, some vectors are returned in registers.
1491     if (IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1492       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
1493 
1494       // 128-bit vectors are a special case; they are returned in
1495       // registers and we need to make sure to pick a type the LLVM
1496       // backend will like.
1497       if (Size == 128)
1498         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::FixedVectorType::get(
1499             llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2));
1500 
1501       // Always return in register if it fits in a general purpose
1502       // register, or if it is 64 bits and has a single element.
1503       if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) ||
1504           (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1))
1505         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
1506                                                             Size));
1507 
1508       return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1509     }
1510 
1511     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1512   }
1513 
1514   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
1515     if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1516       // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
1517       if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
1518         return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1519     }
1520 
1521     // If specified, structs and unions are always indirect.
1522     if (!IsRetSmallStructInRegABI && !RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
1523       return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1524 
1525     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
1526     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
1527       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1528 
1529     // Small structures which are register sized are generally returned
1530     // in a register.
1531     if (shouldReturnTypeInRegister(RetTy, getContext())) {
1532       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
1533 
1534       // As a special-case, if the struct is a "single-element" struct, and
1535       // the field is of type "float" or "double", return it in a
1536       // floating-point register. (MSVC does not apply this special case.)
1537       // We apply a similar transformation for pointer types to improve the
1538       // quality of the generated IR.
1539       if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext()))
1540         if ((!IsWin32StructABI && SeltTy->isRealFloatingType())
1541             || SeltTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
1542           return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
1543 
1544       // FIXME: We should be able to narrow this integer in cases with dead
1545       // padding.
1546       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),Size));
1547     }
1548 
1549     return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1550   }
1551 
1552   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
1553   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
1554     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1555 
1556   if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
1557     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
1558       return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1559 
1560   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
1561                                                : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
1562 }
1563 
1564 static bool isSIMDVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
1565   return Ty->getAs<VectorType>() && Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == 128;
1566 }
1567 
1568 static bool isRecordWithSIMDVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
1569   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1570   if (!RT)
1571     return 0;
1572   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1573 
1574   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
1575   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
1576     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
1577       if (!isRecordWithSIMDVectorType(Context, I.getType()))
1578         return false;
1579 
1580   for (const auto *i : RD->fields()) {
1581     QualType FT = i->getType();
1582 
1583     if (isSIMDVectorType(Context, FT))
1584       return true;
1585 
1586     if (isRecordWithSIMDVectorType(Context, FT))
1587       return true;
1588   }
1589 
1590   return false;
1591 }
1592 
1593 unsigned X86_32ABIInfo::getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty,
1594                                                  unsigned Align) const {
1595   // Otherwise, if the alignment is less than or equal to the minimum ABI
1596   // alignment, just use the default; the backend will handle this.
1597   if (Align <= MinABIStackAlignInBytes)
1598     return 0; // Use default alignment.
1599 
1600   // On non-Darwin, the stack type alignment is always 4.
1601   if (!IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1602     // Set explicit alignment, since we may need to realign the top.
1603     return MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
1604   }
1605 
1606   // Otherwise, if the type contains an SSE vector type, the alignment is 16.
1607   if (Align >= 16 && (isSIMDVectorType(getContext(), Ty) ||
1608                       isRecordWithSIMDVectorType(getContext(), Ty)))
1609     return 16;
1610 
1611   return MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
1612 }
1613 
1614 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal,
1615                                             CCState &State) const {
1616   if (!ByVal) {
1617     if (State.FreeRegs) {
1618       --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer.
1619       if (!IsMCUABI)
1620         return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty);
1621     }
1622     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false);
1623   }
1624 
1625   // Compute the byval alignment.
1626   unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
1627   unsigned StackAlign = getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeAlign);
1628   if (StackAlign == 0)
1629     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true);
1630 
1631   // If the stack alignment is less than the type alignment, realign the
1632   // argument.
1633   bool Realign = TypeAlign > StackAlign;
1634   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlign),
1635                                  /*ByVal=*/true, Realign);
1636 }
1637 
1638 X86_32ABIInfo::Class X86_32ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty) const {
1639   const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext());
1640   if (!T)
1641     T = Ty.getTypePtr();
1642 
1643   if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1644     BuiltinType::Kind K = BT->getKind();
1645     if (K == BuiltinType::Float || K == BuiltinType::Double)
1646       return Float;
1647   }
1648   return Integer;
1649 }
1650 
1651 bool X86_32ABIInfo::updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
1652   if (!IsSoftFloatABI) {
1653     Class C = classify(Ty);
1654     if (C == Float)
1655       return false;
1656   }
1657 
1658   unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
1659   unsigned SizeInRegs = (Size + 31) / 32;
1660 
1661   if (SizeInRegs == 0)
1662     return false;
1663 
1664   if (!IsMCUABI) {
1665     if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) {
1666       State.FreeRegs = 0;
1667       return false;
1668     }
1669   } else {
1670     // The MCU psABI allows passing parameters in-reg even if there are
1671     // earlier parameters that are passed on the stack. Also,
1672     // it does not allow passing >8-byte structs in-register,
1673     // even if there are 3 free registers available.
1674     if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs || SizeInRegs > 2)
1675       return false;
1676   }
1677 
1678   State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
1679   return true;
1680 }
1681 
1682 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State,
1683                                              bool &InReg,
1684                                              bool &NeedsPadding) const {
1685   // On Windows, aggregates other than HFAs are never passed in registers, and
1686   // they do not consume register slots. Homogenous floating-point aggregates
1687   // (HFAs) have already been dealt with at this point.
1688   if (IsWin32StructABI && isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty))
1689     return false;
1690 
1691   NeedsPadding = false;
1692   InReg = !IsMCUABI;
1693 
1694   if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State))
1695     return false;
1696 
1697   if (IsMCUABI)
1698     return true;
1699 
1700   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall ||
1701       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1702       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1703     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32 && State.FreeRegs)
1704       NeedsPadding = true;
1705 
1706     return false;
1707   }
1708 
1709   return true;
1710 }
1711 
1712 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
1713   if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State))
1714     return false;
1715 
1716   if (IsMCUABI)
1717     return false;
1718 
1719   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall ||
1720       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1721       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1722     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 32)
1723       return false;
1724 
1725     return (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || Ty->isPointerType() ||
1726         Ty->isReferenceType());
1727   }
1728 
1729   return true;
1730 }
1731 
1732 void X86_32ABIInfo::runVectorCallFirstPass(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State) const {
1733   // Vectorcall x86 works subtly different than in x64, so the format is
1734   // a bit different than the x64 version.  First, all vector types (not HVAs)
1735   // are assigned, with the first 6 ending up in the [XYZ]MM0-5 registers.
1736   // This differs from the x64 implementation, where the first 6 by INDEX get
1737   // registers.
1738   // In the second pass over the arguments, HVAs are passed in the remaining
1739   // vector registers if possible, or indirectly by address. The address will be
1740   // passed in ECX/EDX if available. Any other arguments are passed according to
1741   // the usual fastcall rules.
1742   MutableArrayRef<CGFunctionInfoArgInfo> Args = FI.arguments();
1743   for (int I = 0, E = Args.size(); I < E; ++I) {
1744     const Type *Base = nullptr;
1745     uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1746     const QualType &Ty = Args[I].type;
1747     if ((Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isBuiltinType()) &&
1748         isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
1749       if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
1750         State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
1751         Args[I].info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
1752         State.IsPreassigned.set(I);
1753       }
1754     }
1755   }
1756 }
1757 
1758 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
1759                                                CCState &State) const {
1760   // FIXME: Set alignment on indirect arguments.
1761   bool IsFastCall = State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall;
1762   bool IsRegCall = State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall;
1763   bool IsVectorCall = State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall;
1764 
1765   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
1766   TypeInfo TI = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty);
1767 
1768   // Check with the C++ ABI first.
1769   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1770   if (RT) {
1771     CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI());
1772     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) {
1773       return getIndirectResult(Ty, false, State);
1774     } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) {
1775       // The field index doesn't matter, we'll fix it up later.
1776       return ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(/*FieldIndex=*/0);
1777     }
1778   }
1779 
1780   // Regcall uses the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar
1781   // to other targets.
1782   const Type *Base = nullptr;
1783   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1784   if ((IsRegCall || IsVectorCall) &&
1785       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
1786     if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
1787       State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
1788 
1789       // Vectorcall passes HVAs directly and does not flatten them, but regcall
1790       // does.
1791       if (IsVectorCall)
1792         return getDirectX86Hva();
1793 
1794       if (Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())
1795         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1796       return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
1797     }
1798     return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1799   }
1800 
1801   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
1802     // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
1803     // FIXME: This should not be byval!
1804     if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
1805       return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
1806 
1807     // Ignore empty structs/unions on non-Windows.
1808     if (!IsWin32StructABI && isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
1809       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1810 
1811     llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext();
1812     llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext);
1813     bool NeedsPadding = false;
1814     bool InReg;
1815     if (shouldAggregateUseDirect(Ty, State, InReg, NeedsPadding)) {
1816       unsigned SizeInRegs = (TI.Width + 31) / 32;
1817       SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32);
1818       llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements);
1819       if (InReg)
1820         return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result);
1821       else
1822         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result);
1823     }
1824     llvm::IntegerType *PaddingType = NeedsPadding ? Int32 : nullptr;
1825 
1826     // Pass over-aligned aggregates on Windows indirectly. This behavior was
1827     // added in MSVC 2015.
1828     if (IsWin32StructABI && TI.AlignIsRequired && TI.Align > 32)
1829       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1830 
1831     // Expand small (<= 128-bit) record types when we know that the stack layout
1832     // of those arguments will match the struct. This is important because the
1833     // LLVM backend isn't smart enough to remove byval, which inhibits many
1834     // optimizations.
1835     // Don't do this for the MCU if there are still free integer registers
1836     // (see X86_64 ABI for full explanation).
1837     if (TI.Width <= 4 * 32 && (!IsMCUABI || State.FreeRegs == 0) &&
1838         canExpandIndirectArgument(Ty))
1839       return ABIArgInfo::getExpandWithPadding(
1840           IsFastCall || IsVectorCall || IsRegCall, PaddingType);
1841 
1842     return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
1843   }
1844 
1845   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
1846     // On Windows, vectors are passed directly if registers are available, or
1847     // indirectly if not. This avoids the need to align argument memory. Pass
1848     // user-defined vector types larger than 512 bits indirectly for simplicity.
1849     if (IsWin32StructABI) {
1850       if (TI.Width <= 512 && State.FreeSSERegs > 0) {
1851         --State.FreeSSERegs;
1852         return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
1853       }
1854       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1855     }
1856 
1857     // On Darwin, some vectors are passed in memory, we handle this by passing
1858     // it as an i8/i16/i32/i64.
1859     if (IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1860       if ((TI.Width == 8 || TI.Width == 16 || TI.Width == 32) ||
1861           (TI.Width == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1))
1862         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
1863             llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), TI.Width));
1864     }
1865 
1866     if (IsX86_MMXType(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)))
1867       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64));
1868 
1869     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1870   }
1871 
1872 
1873   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
1874     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1875 
1876   bool InReg = shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(Ty, State);
1877 
1878   if (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty)) {
1879     if (InReg)
1880       return ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(Ty);
1881     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
1882   }
1883 
1884   if (const auto * EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
1885     if (EIT->getNumBits() <= 64) {
1886       if (InReg)
1887         return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
1888       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1889     }
1890     return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1891   }
1892 
1893   if (InReg)
1894     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
1895   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1896 }
1897 
1898 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
1899   CCState State(FI);
1900   if (IsMCUABI)
1901     State.FreeRegs = 3;
1902   else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall) {
1903     State.FreeRegs = 2;
1904     State.FreeSSERegs = 3;
1905   } else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) {
1906     State.FreeRegs = 2;
1907     State.FreeSSERegs = 6;
1908   } else if (FI.getHasRegParm())
1909     State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm();
1910   else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1911     State.FreeRegs = 5;
1912     State.FreeSSERegs = 8;
1913   } else if (IsWin32StructABI) {
1914     // Since MSVC 2015, the first three SSE vectors have been passed in
1915     // registers. The rest are passed indirectly.
1916     State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters;
1917     State.FreeSSERegs = 3;
1918   } else
1919     State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters;
1920 
1921   if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) {
1922     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), State);
1923   } else if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) {
1924     // The C++ ABI is not aware of register usage, so we have to check if the
1925     // return value was sret and put it in a register ourselves if appropriate.
1926     if (State.FreeRegs) {
1927       --State.FreeRegs;  // The sret parameter consumes a register.
1928       if (!IsMCUABI)
1929         FI.getReturnInfo().setInReg(true);
1930     }
1931   }
1932 
1933   // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register.
1934   if (FI.isChainCall())
1935     ++State.FreeRegs;
1936 
1937   // For vectorcall, do a first pass over the arguments, assigning FP and vector
1938   // arguments to XMM registers as available.
1939   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall)
1940     runVectorCallFirstPass(FI, State);
1941 
1942   bool UsedInAlloca = false;
1943   MutableArrayRef<CGFunctionInfoArgInfo> Args = FI.arguments();
1944   for (int I = 0, E = Args.size(); I < E; ++I) {
1945     // Skip arguments that have already been assigned.
1946     if (State.IsPreassigned.test(I))
1947       continue;
1948 
1949     Args[I].info = classifyArgumentType(Args[I].type, State);
1950     UsedInAlloca |= (Args[I].info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca);
1951   }
1952 
1953   // If we needed to use inalloca for any argument, do a second pass and rewrite
1954   // all the memory arguments to use inalloca.
1955   if (UsedInAlloca)
1956     rewriteWithInAlloca(FI);
1957 }
1958 
1959 void
1960 X86_32ABIInfo::addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields,
1961                                    CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info,
1962                                    QualType Type) const {
1963   // Arguments are always 4-byte-aligned.
1964   CharUnits WordSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
1965   assert(StackOffset.isMultipleOf(WordSize) && "unaligned inalloca struct");
1966 
1967   // sret pointers and indirect things will require an extra pointer
1968   // indirection, unless they are byval. Most things are byval, and will not
1969   // require this indirection.
1970   bool IsIndirect = false;
1971   if (Info.isIndirect() && !Info.getIndirectByVal())
1972     IsIndirect = true;
1973   Info = ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(FrameFields.size(), IsIndirect);
1974   llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertTypeForMem(Type);
1975   if (IsIndirect)
1976     LLTy = LLTy->getPointerTo(0);
1977   FrameFields.push_back(LLTy);
1978   StackOffset += IsIndirect ? WordSize : getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Type);
1979 
1980   // Insert padding bytes to respect alignment.
1981   CharUnits FieldEnd = StackOffset;
1982   StackOffset = FieldEnd.alignTo(WordSize);
1983   if (StackOffset != FieldEnd) {
1984     CharUnits NumBytes = StackOffset - FieldEnd;
1985     llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext());
1986     Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(Ty, NumBytes.getQuantity());
1987     FrameFields.push_back(Ty);
1988   }
1989 }
1990 
1991 static bool isArgInAlloca(const ABIArgInfo &Info) {
1992   // Leave ignored and inreg arguments alone.
1993   switch (Info.getKind()) {
1994   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
1995     return true;
1996   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
1997   case ABIArgInfo::IndirectAliased:
1998     return false;
1999   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
2000   case ABIArgInfo::Direct:
2001   case ABIArgInfo::Extend:
2002     return !Info.getInReg();
2003   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
2004   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
2005     // These are aggregate types which are never passed in registers when
2006     // inalloca is involved.
2007     return true;
2008   }
2009   llvm_unreachable("invalid enum");
2010 }
2011 
2012 void X86_32ABIInfo::rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
2013   assert(IsWin32StructABI && "inalloca only supported on win32");
2014 
2015   // Build a packed struct type for all of the arguments in memory.
2016   SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> FrameFields;
2017 
2018   // The stack alignment is always 4.
2019   CharUnits StackAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
2020 
2021   CharUnits StackOffset;
2022   CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator I = FI.arg_begin(), E = FI.arg_end();
2023 
2024   // Put 'this' into the struct before 'sret', if necessary.
2025   bool IsThisCall =
2026       FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_ThisCall;
2027   ABIArgInfo &Ret = FI.getReturnInfo();
2028   if (Ret.isIndirect() && Ret.isSRetAfterThis() && !IsThisCall &&
2029       isArgInAlloca(I->info)) {
2030     addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type);
2031     ++I;
2032   }
2033 
2034   // Put the sret parameter into the inalloca struct if it's in memory.
2035   if (Ret.isIndirect() && !Ret.getInReg()) {
2036     addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, Ret, FI.getReturnType());
2037     // On Windows, the hidden sret parameter is always returned in eax.
2038     Ret.setInAllocaSRet(IsWin32StructABI);
2039   }
2040 
2041   // Skip the 'this' parameter in ecx.
2042   if (IsThisCall)
2043     ++I;
2044 
2045   // Put arguments passed in memory into the struct.
2046   for (; I != E; ++I) {
2047     if (isArgInAlloca(I->info))
2048       addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type);
2049   }
2050 
2051   FI.setArgStruct(llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), FrameFields,
2052                                         /*isPacked=*/true),
2053                   StackAlign);
2054 }
2055 
2056 Address X86_32ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2057                                  Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const {
2058 
2059   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
2060 
2061   // x86-32 changes the alignment of certain arguments on the stack.
2062   //
2063   // Just messing with TypeInfo like this works because we never pass
2064   // anything indirectly.
2065   TypeInfo.Align = CharUnits::fromQuantity(
2066                 getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeInfo.Align.getQuantity()));
2067 
2068   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false,
2069                           TypeInfo, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
2070                           /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
2071 }
2072 
2073 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(
2074     const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) {
2075   assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86);
2076 
2077   switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) {
2078   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default:
2079     break;
2080   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack:  // -fpcc-struct-return
2081     return false;
2082   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs:  // -freg-struct-return
2083     return true;
2084   }
2085 
2086   if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.isOSIAMCU())
2087     return true;
2088 
2089   switch (Triple.getOS()) {
2090   case llvm::Triple::DragonFly:
2091   case llvm::Triple::FreeBSD:
2092   case llvm::Triple::OpenBSD:
2093   case llvm::Triple::Win32:
2094     return true;
2095   default:
2096     return false;
2097   }
2098 }
2099 
2100 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
2101     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
2102   if (GV->isDeclaration())
2103     return;
2104   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2105     if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) {
2106       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2107       Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign");
2108     }
2109     if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
2110       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2111       Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
2112     }
2113   }
2114 }
2115 
2116 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(
2117                                                CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2118                                                llvm::Value *Address) const {
2119   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
2120 
2121   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
2122 
2123   // 0-7 are the eight integer registers;  the order is different
2124   //   on Darwin (for EH), but the range is the same.
2125   // 8 is %eip.
2126   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 8);
2127 
2128   if (CGF.CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) {
2129     // 12-16 are st(0..4).  Not sure why we stop at 4.
2130     // These have size 16, which is sizeof(long double) on
2131     // platforms with 8-byte alignment for that type.
2132     llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 16);
2133     AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 12, 16);
2134 
2135   } else {
2136     // 9 is %eflags, which doesn't get a size on Darwin for some
2137     // reason.
2138     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(
2139         Four8, Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(CGF.Int8Ty, Address, 9),
2140                                CharUnits::One());
2141 
2142     // 11-16 are st(0..5).  Not sure why we stop at 5.
2143     // These have size 12, which is sizeof(long double) on
2144     // platforms with 4-byte alignment for that type.
2145     llvm::Value *Twelve8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 12);
2146     AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Twelve8, 11, 16);
2147   }
2148 
2149   return false;
2150 }
2151 
2152 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2153 // X86-64 ABI Implementation
2154 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2155 
2156 
2157 namespace {
2158 /// The AVX ABI level for X86 targets.
2159 enum class X86AVXABILevel {
2160   None,
2161   AVX,
2162   AVX512
2163 };
2164 
2165 /// \p returns the size in bits of the largest (native) vector for \p AVXLevel.
2166 static unsigned getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) {
2167   switch (AVXLevel) {
2168   case X86AVXABILevel::AVX512:
2169     return 512;
2170   case X86AVXABILevel::AVX:
2171     return 256;
2172   case X86AVXABILevel::None:
2173     return 128;
2174   }
2175   llvm_unreachable("Unknown AVXLevel");
2176 }
2177 
2178 /// X86_64ABIInfo - The X86_64 ABI information.
2179 class X86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
2180   enum Class {
2181     Integer = 0,
2182     SSE,
2183     SSEUp,
2184     X87,
2185     X87Up,
2186     ComplexX87,
2187     NoClass,
2188     Memory
2189   };
2190 
2191   /// merge - Implement the X86_64 ABI merging algorithm.
2192   ///
2193   /// Merge an accumulating classification \arg Accum with a field
2194   /// classification \arg Field.
2195   ///
2196   /// \param Accum - The accumulating classification. This should
2197   /// always be either NoClass or the result of a previous merge
2198   /// call. In addition, this should never be Memory (the caller
2199   /// should just return Memory for the aggregate).
2200   static Class merge(Class Accum, Class Field);
2201 
2202   /// postMerge - Implement the X86_64 ABI post merging algorithm.
2203   ///
2204   /// Post merger cleanup, reduces a malformed Hi and Lo pair to
2205   /// final MEMORY or SSE classes when necessary.
2206   ///
2207   /// \param AggregateSize - The size of the current aggregate in
2208   /// the classification process.
2209   ///
2210   /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type
2211   /// residing in the low word of the containing object.
2212   ///
2213   /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type
2214   /// residing in the higher words of the containing object.
2215   ///
2216   void postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, Class &Hi) const;
2217 
2218   /// classify - Determine the x86_64 register classes in which the
2219   /// given type T should be passed.
2220   ///
2221   /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type
2222   /// residing in the low word of the containing object.
2223   ///
2224   /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type
2225   /// residing in the high word of the containing object.
2226   ///
2227   /// \param OffsetBase - The bit offset of this type in the
2228   /// containing object.  Some parameters are classified different
2229   /// depending on whether they straddle an eightbyte boundary.
2230   ///
2231   /// \param isNamedArg - Whether the argument in question is a "named"
2232   /// argument, as used in AMD64-ABI 3.5.7.
2233   ///
2234   /// If a word is unused its result will be NoClass; if a type should
2235   /// be passed in Memory then at least the classification of \arg Lo
2236   /// will be Memory.
2237   ///
2238   /// The \arg Lo class will be NoClass iff the argument is ignored.
2239   ///
2240   /// If the \arg Lo class is ComplexX87, then the \arg Hi class will
2241   /// also be ComplexX87.
2242   void classify(QualType T, uint64_t OffsetBase, Class &Lo, Class &Hi,
2243                 bool isNamedArg) const;
2244 
2245   llvm::Type *GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
2246   llvm::Type *GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType,
2247                                  unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy,
2248                                  unsigned SourceOffset) const;
2249   llvm::Type *GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType,
2250                                      unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy,
2251                                      unsigned SourceOffset) const;
2252 
2253   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
2254   /// such that the argument will be returned in memory.
2255   ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const;
2256 
2257   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
2258   /// such that the argument will be passed in memory.
2259   ///
2260   /// \param freeIntRegs - The number of free integer registers remaining
2261   /// available.
2262   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs) const;
2263 
2264   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
2265 
2266   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs,
2267                                   unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE,
2268                                   bool isNamedArg) const;
2269 
2270   ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
2271                                        unsigned &NeededSSE) const;
2272 
2273   ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
2274                                            unsigned &NeededSSE) const;
2275 
2276   bool IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
2277 
2278   /// The 0.98 ABI revision clarified a lot of ambiguities,
2279   /// unfortunately in ways that were not always consistent with
2280   /// certain previous compilers.  In particular, platforms which
2281   /// required strict binary compatibility with older versions of GCC
2282   /// may need to exempt themselves.
2283   bool honorsRevision0_98() const {
2284     return !getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin();
2285   }
2286 
2287   /// GCC classifies <1 x long long> as SSE but some platform ABIs choose to
2288   /// classify it as INTEGER (for compatibility with older clang compilers).
2289   bool classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() const {
2290     // Clang <= 3.8 did not do this.
2291     if (getContext().getLangOpts().getClangABICompat() <=
2292         LangOptions::ClangABI::Ver3_8)
2293       return false;
2294 
2295     const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple();
2296     if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::PS4)
2297       return false;
2298     if (Triple.isOSFreeBSD() && Triple.getOSMajorVersion() >= 10)
2299       return false;
2300     return true;
2301   }
2302 
2303   // GCC classifies vectors of __int128 as memory.
2304   bool passInt128VectorsInMem() const {
2305     // Clang <= 9.0 did not do this.
2306     if (getContext().getLangOpts().getClangABICompat() <=
2307         LangOptions::ClangABI::Ver9)
2308       return false;
2309 
2310     const llvm::Triple &T = getTarget().getTriple();
2311     return T.isOSLinux() || T.isOSNetBSD();
2312   }
2313 
2314   X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel;
2315   // Some ABIs (e.g. X32 ABI and Native Client OS) use 32 bit pointers on
2316   // 64-bit hardware.
2317   bool Has64BitPointers;
2318 
2319 public:
2320   X86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) :
2321       SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel),
2322       Has64BitPointers(CGT.getDataLayout().getPointerSize(0) == 8) {
2323   }
2324 
2325   bool isPassedUsingAVXType(QualType type) const {
2326     unsigned neededInt, neededSSE;
2327     // The freeIntRegs argument doesn't matter here.
2328     ABIArgInfo info = classifyArgumentType(type, 0, neededInt, neededSSE,
2329                                            /*isNamedArg*/true);
2330     if (info.isDirect()) {
2331       llvm::Type *ty = info.getCoerceToType();
2332       if (llvm::VectorType *vectorTy = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::VectorType>(ty))
2333         return vectorTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits().getFixedSize() > 128;
2334     }
2335     return false;
2336   }
2337 
2338   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
2339 
2340   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2341                     QualType Ty) const override;
2342   Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2343                       QualType Ty) const override;
2344 
2345   bool has64BitPointers() const {
2346     return Has64BitPointers;
2347   }
2348 
2349   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
2350                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
2351     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
2352   }
2353   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
2354     return true;
2355   }
2356 };
2357 
2358 /// WinX86_64ABIInfo - The Windows X86_64 ABI information.
2359 class WinX86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
2360 public:
2361   WinX86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2362       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel),
2363         IsMingw64(getTarget().getTriple().isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) {}
2364 
2365   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
2366 
2367   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2368                     QualType Ty) const override;
2369 
2370   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override {
2371     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
2372     return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty);
2373   }
2374 
2375   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
2376                                          uint64_t NumMembers) const override {
2377     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
2378     return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers);
2379   }
2380 
2381   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type *> scalars,
2382                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
2383     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
2384   }
2385 
2386   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
2387     return true;
2388   }
2389 
2390 private:
2391   ABIArgInfo classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, bool IsReturnType,
2392                       bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const;
2393   ABIArgInfo reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
2394                                       const ABIArgInfo &current) const;
2395   void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, unsigned FreeSSERegs,
2396                              bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const;
2397 
2398   X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel;
2399 
2400   bool IsMingw64;
2401 };
2402 
2403 class X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
2404 public:
2405   X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2406       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<X86_64ABIInfo>(CGT, AVXLevel)) {}
2407 
2408   const X86_64ABIInfo &getABIInfo() const {
2409     return static_cast<const X86_64ABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo());
2410   }
2411 
2412   /// Disable tail call on x86-64. The epilogue code before the tail jump blocks
2413   /// autoreleaseRV/retainRV and autoreleaseRV/unsafeClaimRV optimizations.
2414   bool markARCOptimizedReturnCallsAsNoTail() const override { return true; }
2415 
2416   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2417     return 7;
2418   }
2419 
2420   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2421                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
2422     llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8);
2423 
2424     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
2425     // 16 is %rip.
2426     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16);
2427     return false;
2428   }
2429 
2430   llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2431                                   StringRef Constraint,
2432                                   llvm::Type* Ty) const override {
2433     return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty);
2434   }
2435 
2436   bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args,
2437                              const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override {
2438     // The default CC on x86-64 sets %al to the number of SSA
2439     // registers used, and GCC sets this when calling an unprototyped
2440     // function, so we override the default behavior.  However, don't do
2441     // that when AVX types are involved: the ABI explicitly states it is
2442     // undefined, and it doesn't work in practice because of how the ABI
2443     // defines varargs anyway.
2444     if (fnType->getCallConv() == CC_C) {
2445       bool HasAVXType = false;
2446       for (CallArgList::const_iterator
2447              it = args.begin(), ie = args.end(); it != ie; ++it) {
2448         if (getABIInfo().isPassedUsingAVXType(it->Ty)) {
2449           HasAVXType = true;
2450           break;
2451         }
2452       }
2453 
2454       if (!HasAVXType)
2455         return true;
2456     }
2457 
2458     return TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(args, fnType);
2459   }
2460 
2461   llvm::Constant *
2462   getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2463     unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) | // jmp rel8
2464                    (0x06 << 8) | //           .+0x08
2465                    ('v' << 16) |
2466                    ('2' << 24);
2467     return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig);
2468   }
2469 
2470   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2471                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2472     if (GV->isDeclaration())
2473       return;
2474     if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2475       if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) {
2476         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2477         Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign");
2478       }
2479       if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
2480         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2481         Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
2482       }
2483     }
2484   }
2485 
2486   void checkFunctionCallABI(CodeGenModule &CGM, SourceLocation CallLoc,
2487                             const FunctionDecl *Caller,
2488                             const FunctionDecl *Callee,
2489                             const CallArgList &Args) const override;
2490 };
2491 
2492 static void initFeatureMaps(const ASTContext &Ctx,
2493                             llvm::StringMap<bool> &CallerMap,
2494                             const FunctionDecl *Caller,
2495                             llvm::StringMap<bool> &CalleeMap,
2496                             const FunctionDecl *Callee) {
2497   if (CalleeMap.empty() && CallerMap.empty()) {
2498     // The caller is potentially nullptr in the case where the call isn't in a
2499     // function.  In this case, the getFunctionFeatureMap ensures we just get
2500     // the TU level setting (since it cannot be modified by 'target'..
2501     Ctx.getFunctionFeatureMap(CallerMap, Caller);
2502     Ctx.getFunctionFeatureMap(CalleeMap, Callee);
2503   }
2504 }
2505 
2506 static bool checkAVXParamFeature(DiagnosticsEngine &Diag,
2507                                  SourceLocation CallLoc,
2508                                  const llvm::StringMap<bool> &CallerMap,
2509                                  const llvm::StringMap<bool> &CalleeMap,
2510                                  QualType Ty, StringRef Feature,
2511                                  bool IsArgument) {
2512   bool CallerHasFeat = CallerMap.lookup(Feature);
2513   bool CalleeHasFeat = CalleeMap.lookup(Feature);
2514   if (!CallerHasFeat && !CalleeHasFeat)
2515     return Diag.Report(CallLoc, diag::warn_avx_calling_convention)
2516            << IsArgument << Ty << Feature;
2517 
2518   // Mixing calling conventions here is very clearly an error.
2519   if (!CallerHasFeat || !CalleeHasFeat)
2520     return Diag.Report(CallLoc, diag::err_avx_calling_convention)
2521            << IsArgument << Ty << Feature;
2522 
2523   // Else, both caller and callee have the required feature, so there is no need
2524   // to diagnose.
2525   return false;
2526 }
2527 
2528 static bool checkAVXParam(DiagnosticsEngine &Diag, ASTContext &Ctx,
2529                           SourceLocation CallLoc,
2530                           const llvm::StringMap<bool> &CallerMap,
2531                           const llvm::StringMap<bool> &CalleeMap, QualType Ty,
2532                           bool IsArgument) {
2533   uint64_t Size = Ctx.getTypeSize(Ty);
2534   if (Size > 256)
2535     return checkAVXParamFeature(Diag, CallLoc, CallerMap, CalleeMap, Ty,
2536                                 "avx512f", IsArgument);
2537 
2538   if (Size > 128)
2539     return checkAVXParamFeature(Diag, CallLoc, CallerMap, CalleeMap, Ty, "avx",
2540                                 IsArgument);
2541 
2542   return false;
2543 }
2544 
2545 void X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::checkFunctionCallABI(
2546     CodeGenModule &CGM, SourceLocation CallLoc, const FunctionDecl *Caller,
2547     const FunctionDecl *Callee, const CallArgList &Args) const {
2548   llvm::StringMap<bool> CallerMap;
2549   llvm::StringMap<bool> CalleeMap;
2550   unsigned ArgIndex = 0;
2551 
2552   // We need to loop through the actual call arguments rather than the the
2553   // function's parameters, in case this variadic.
2554   for (const CallArg &Arg : Args) {
2555     // The "avx" feature changes how vectors >128 in size are passed. "avx512f"
2556     // additionally changes how vectors >256 in size are passed. Like GCC, we
2557     // warn when a function is called with an argument where this will change.
2558     // Unlike GCC, we also error when it is an obvious ABI mismatch, that is,
2559     // the caller and callee features are mismatched.
2560     // Unfortunately, we cannot do this diagnostic in SEMA, since the callee can
2561     // change its ABI with attribute-target after this call.
2562     if (Arg.getType()->isVectorType() &&
2563         CGM.getContext().getTypeSize(Arg.getType()) > 128) {
2564       initFeatureMaps(CGM.getContext(), CallerMap, Caller, CalleeMap, Callee);
2565       QualType Ty = Arg.getType();
2566       // The CallArg seems to have desugared the type already, so for clearer
2567       // diagnostics, replace it with the type in the FunctionDecl if possible.
2568       if (ArgIndex < Callee->getNumParams())
2569         Ty = Callee->getParamDecl(ArgIndex)->getType();
2570 
2571       if (checkAVXParam(CGM.getDiags(), CGM.getContext(), CallLoc, CallerMap,
2572                         CalleeMap, Ty, /*IsArgument*/ true))
2573         return;
2574     }
2575     ++ArgIndex;
2576   }
2577 
2578   // Check return always, as we don't have a good way of knowing in codegen
2579   // whether this value is used, tail-called, etc.
2580   if (Callee->getReturnType()->isVectorType() &&
2581       CGM.getContext().getTypeSize(Callee->getReturnType()) > 128) {
2582     initFeatureMaps(CGM.getContext(), CallerMap, Caller, CalleeMap, Callee);
2583     checkAVXParam(CGM.getDiags(), CGM.getContext(), CallLoc, CallerMap,
2584                   CalleeMap, Callee->getReturnType(),
2585                   /*IsArgument*/ false);
2586   }
2587 }
2588 
2589 static std::string qualifyWindowsLibrary(llvm::StringRef Lib) {
2590   // If the argument does not end in .lib, automatically add the suffix.
2591   // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes.
2592   // This matches the behavior of MSVC.
2593   bool Quote = (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos);
2594   std::string ArgStr = Quote ? "\"" : "";
2595   ArgStr += Lib;
2596   if (!Lib.endswith_lower(".lib") && !Lib.endswith_lower(".a"))
2597     ArgStr += ".lib";
2598   ArgStr += Quote ? "\"" : "";
2599   return ArgStr;
2600 }
2601 
2602 class WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo {
2603 public:
2604   WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT,
2605         bool DarwinVectorABI, bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
2606         unsigned NumRegisterParameters)
2607     : X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
2608         Win32StructABI, NumRegisterParameters, false) {}
2609 
2610   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2611                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
2612 
2613   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
2614                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
2615     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:";
2616     Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
2617   }
2618 
2619   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name,
2620                                llvm::StringRef Value,
2621                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
2622     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
2623   }
2624 };
2625 
2626 static void addStackProbeTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2627                                           CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) {
2628   if (llvm::Function *Fn = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::Function>(GV)) {
2629 
2630     if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize != 4096)
2631       Fn->addFnAttr("stack-probe-size",
2632                     llvm::utostr(CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize));
2633     if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().NoStackArgProbe)
2634       Fn->addFnAttr("no-stack-arg-probe");
2635   }
2636 }
2637 
2638 void WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
2639     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
2640   X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2641   if (GV->isDeclaration())
2642     return;
2643   addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2644 }
2645 
2646 class WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
2647 public:
2648   WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT,
2649                              X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2650       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<WinX86_64ABIInfo>(CGT, AVXLevel)) {}
2651 
2652   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2653                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
2654 
2655   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2656     return 7;
2657   }
2658 
2659   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2660                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
2661     llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8);
2662 
2663     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
2664     // 16 is %rip.
2665     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16);
2666     return false;
2667   }
2668 
2669   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
2670                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
2671     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:";
2672     Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
2673   }
2674 
2675   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name,
2676                                llvm::StringRef Value,
2677                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
2678     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
2679   }
2680 };
2681 
2682 void WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
2683     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
2684   TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2685   if (GV->isDeclaration())
2686     return;
2687   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2688     if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) {
2689       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2690       Fn->addFnAttr("stackrealign");
2691     }
2692     if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
2693       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2694       Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
2695     }
2696   }
2697 
2698   addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2699 }
2700 }
2701 
2702 void X86_64ABIInfo::postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo,
2703                               Class &Hi) const {
2704   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 5. Then a post merger cleanup is done:
2705   //
2706   // (a) If one of the classes is Memory, the whole argument is passed in
2707   //     memory.
2708   //
2709   // (b) If X87UP is not preceded by X87, the whole argument is passed in
2710   //     memory.
2711   //
2712   // (c) If the size of the aggregate exceeds two eightbytes and the first
2713   //     eightbyte isn't SSE or any other eightbyte isn't SSEUP, the whole
2714   //     argument is passed in memory. NOTE: This is necessary to keep the
2715   //     ABI working for processors that don't support the __m256 type.
2716   //
2717   // (d) If SSEUP is not preceded by SSE or SSEUP, it is converted to SSE.
2718   //
2719   // Some of these are enforced by the merging logic.  Others can arise
2720   // only with unions; for example:
2721   //   union { _Complex double; unsigned; }
2722   //
2723   // Note that clauses (b) and (c) were added in 0.98.
2724   //
2725   if (Hi == Memory)
2726     Lo = Memory;
2727   if (Hi == X87Up && Lo != X87 && honorsRevision0_98())
2728     Lo = Memory;
2729   if (AggregateSize > 128 && (Lo != SSE || Hi != SSEUp))
2730     Lo = Memory;
2731   if (Hi == SSEUp && Lo != SSE)
2732     Hi = SSE;
2733 }
2734 
2735 X86_64ABIInfo::Class X86_64ABIInfo::merge(Class Accum, Class Field) {
2736   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 4. Each field of an object is
2737   // classified recursively so that always two fields are
2738   // considered. The resulting class is calculated according to
2739   // the classes of the fields in the eightbyte:
2740   //
2741   // (a) If both classes are equal, this is the resulting class.
2742   //
2743   // (b) If one of the classes is NO_CLASS, the resulting class is
2744   // the other class.
2745   //
2746   // (c) If one of the classes is MEMORY, the result is the MEMORY
2747   // class.
2748   //
2749   // (d) If one of the classes is INTEGER, the result is the
2750   // INTEGER.
2751   //
2752   // (e) If one of the classes is X87, X87UP, COMPLEX_X87 class,
2753   // MEMORY is used as class.
2754   //
2755   // (f) Otherwise class SSE is used.
2756 
2757   // Accum should never be memory (we should have returned) or
2758   // ComplexX87 (because this cannot be passed in a structure).
2759   assert((Accum != Memory && Accum != ComplexX87) &&
2760          "Invalid accumulated classification during merge.");
2761   if (Accum == Field || Field == NoClass)
2762     return Accum;
2763   if (Field == Memory)
2764     return Memory;
2765   if (Accum == NoClass)
2766     return Field;
2767   if (Accum == Integer || Field == Integer)
2768     return Integer;
2769   if (Field == X87 || Field == X87Up || Field == ComplexX87 ||
2770       Accum == X87 || Accum == X87Up)
2771     return Memory;
2772   return SSE;
2773 }
2774 
2775 void X86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, uint64_t OffsetBase,
2776                              Class &Lo, Class &Hi, bool isNamedArg) const {
2777   // FIXME: This code can be simplified by introducing a simple value class for
2778   // Class pairs with appropriate constructor methods for the various
2779   // situations.
2780 
2781   // FIXME: Some of the split computations are wrong; unaligned vectors
2782   // shouldn't be passed in registers for example, so there is no chance they
2783   // can straddle an eightbyte. Verify & simplify.
2784 
2785   Lo = Hi = NoClass;
2786 
2787   Class &Current = OffsetBase < 64 ? Lo : Hi;
2788   Current = Memory;
2789 
2790   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2791     BuiltinType::Kind k = BT->getKind();
2792 
2793     if (k == BuiltinType::Void) {
2794       Current = NoClass;
2795     } else if (k == BuiltinType::Int128 || k == BuiltinType::UInt128) {
2796       Lo = Integer;
2797       Hi = Integer;
2798     } else if (k >= BuiltinType::Bool && k <= BuiltinType::LongLong) {
2799       Current = Integer;
2800     } else if (k == BuiltinType::Float || k == BuiltinType::Double) {
2801       Current = SSE;
2802     } else if (k == BuiltinType::LongDouble) {
2803       const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
2804       if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) {
2805         Lo = SSE;
2806         Hi = SSEUp;
2807       } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) {
2808         Lo = X87;
2809         Hi = X87Up;
2810       } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) {
2811         Current = SSE;
2812       } else
2813         llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!");
2814     }
2815     // FIXME: _Decimal32 and _Decimal64 are SSE.
2816     // FIXME: _float128 and _Decimal128 are (SSE, SSEUp).
2817     return;
2818   }
2819 
2820   if (const EnumType *ET = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2821     // Classify the underlying integer type.
2822     classify(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(), OffsetBase, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg);
2823     return;
2824   }
2825 
2826   if (Ty->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
2827     Current = Integer;
2828     return;
2829   }
2830 
2831   if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2832     if (Ty->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) {
2833       if (Has64BitPointers) {
2834         // If Has64BitPointers, this is an {i64, i64}, so classify both
2835         // Lo and Hi now.
2836         Lo = Hi = Integer;
2837       } else {
2838         // Otherwise, with 32-bit pointers, this is an {i32, i32}. If that
2839         // straddles an eightbyte boundary, Hi should be classified as well.
2840         uint64_t EB_FuncPtr = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2841         uint64_t EB_ThisAdj = (OffsetBase + 64 - 1) / 64;
2842         if (EB_FuncPtr != EB_ThisAdj) {
2843           Lo = Hi = Integer;
2844         } else {
2845           Current = Integer;
2846         }
2847       }
2848     } else {
2849       Current = Integer;
2850     }
2851     return;
2852   }
2853 
2854   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
2855     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
2856     if (Size == 1 || Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) {
2857       // gcc passes the following as integer:
2858       // 4 bytes - <4 x char>, <2 x short>, <1 x int>, <1 x float>
2859       // 2 bytes - <2 x char>, <1 x short>
2860       // 1 byte  - <1 x char>
2861       Current = Integer;
2862 
2863       // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be
2864       // split.
2865       uint64_t EB_Lo = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2866       uint64_t EB_Hi = (OffsetBase + Size - 1) / 64;
2867       if (EB_Lo != EB_Hi)
2868         Hi = Lo;
2869     } else if (Size == 64) {
2870       QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType();
2871 
2872       // gcc passes <1 x double> in memory. :(
2873       if (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
2874         return;
2875 
2876       // gcc passes <1 x long long> as SSE but clang used to unconditionally
2877       // pass them as integer.  For platforms where clang is the de facto
2878       // platform compiler, we must continue to use integer.
2879       if (!classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() &&
2880           (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2881            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) ||
2882            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Long) ||
2883            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULong)))
2884         Current = Integer;
2885       else
2886         Current = SSE;
2887 
2888       // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be
2889       // split.
2890       if (OffsetBase && OffsetBase != 64)
2891         Hi = Lo;
2892     } else if (Size == 128 ||
2893                (isNamedArg && Size <= getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) {
2894       QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType();
2895 
2896       // gcc passes 256 and 512 bit <X x __int128> vectors in memory. :(
2897       if (passInt128VectorsInMem() && Size != 128 &&
2898           (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Int128) ||
2899            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::UInt128)))
2900         return;
2901 
2902       // Arguments of 256-bits are split into four eightbyte chunks. The
2903       // least significant one belongs to class SSE and all the others to class
2904       // SSEUP. The original Lo and Hi design considers that types can't be
2905       // greater than 128-bits, so a 64-bit split in Hi and Lo makes sense.
2906       // This design isn't correct for 256-bits, but since there're no cases
2907       // where the upper parts would need to be inspected, avoid adding
2908       // complexity and just consider Hi to match the 64-256 part.
2909       //
2910       // Note that per 3.5.7 of AMD64-ABI, 256-bit args are only passed in
2911       // registers if they are "named", i.e. not part of the "..." of a
2912       // variadic function.
2913       //
2914       // Similarly, per 3.2.3. of the AVX512 draft, 512-bits ("named") args are
2915       // split into eight eightbyte chunks, one SSE and seven SSEUP.
2916       Lo = SSE;
2917       Hi = SSEUp;
2918     }
2919     return;
2920   }
2921 
2922   if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
2923     QualType ET = getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType());
2924 
2925     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2926     if (ET->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
2927       if (Size <= 64)
2928         Current = Integer;
2929       else if (Size <= 128)
2930         Lo = Hi = Integer;
2931     } else if (ET == getContext().FloatTy) {
2932       Current = SSE;
2933     } else if (ET == getContext().DoubleTy) {
2934       Lo = Hi = SSE;
2935     } else if (ET == getContext().LongDoubleTy) {
2936       const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
2937       if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad())
2938         Current = Memory;
2939       else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended())
2940         Current = ComplexX87;
2941       else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble())
2942         Lo = Hi = SSE;
2943       else
2944         llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!");
2945     }
2946 
2947     // If this complex type crosses an eightbyte boundary then it
2948     // should be split.
2949     uint64_t EB_Real = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2950     uint64_t EB_Imag = (OffsetBase + getContext().getTypeSize(ET)) / 64;
2951     if (Hi == NoClass && EB_Real != EB_Imag)
2952       Hi = Lo;
2953 
2954     return;
2955   }
2956 
2957   if (const auto *EITy = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
2958     if (EITy->getNumBits() <= 64)
2959       Current = Integer;
2960     else if (EITy->getNumBits() <= 128)
2961       Lo = Hi = Integer;
2962     // Larger values need to get passed in memory.
2963     return;
2964   }
2965 
2966   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
2967     // Arrays are treated like structures.
2968 
2969     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2970 
2971     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger
2972     // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY.
2973     if (Size > 512)
2974       return;
2975 
2976     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If ..., or it contains unaligned
2977     // fields, it has class MEMORY.
2978     //
2979     // Only need to check alignment of array base.
2980     if (OffsetBase % getContext().getTypeAlign(AT->getElementType()))
2981       return;
2982 
2983     // Otherwise implement simplified merge. We could be smarter about
2984     // this, but it isn't worth it and would be harder to verify.
2985     Current = NoClass;
2986     uint64_t EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(AT->getElementType());
2987     uint64_t ArraySize = AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
2988 
2989     // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the array
2990     // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended
2991     // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory.
2992     //
2993     if (Size > 128 &&
2994         (Size != EltSize || Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel)))
2995       return;
2996 
2997     for (uint64_t i=0, Offset=OffsetBase; i<ArraySize; ++i, Offset += EltSize) {
2998       Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
2999       classify(AT->getElementType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
3000       Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
3001       Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
3002       if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory)
3003         break;
3004     }
3005 
3006     postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
3007     assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp array classification.");
3008     return;
3009   }
3010 
3011   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3012     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
3013 
3014     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger
3015     // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY.
3016     if (Size > 512)
3017       return;
3018 
3019     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 2. If a C++ object has either a non-trivial
3020     // copy constructor or a non-trivial destructor, it is passed by invisible
3021     // reference.
3022     if (getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()))
3023       return;
3024 
3025     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
3026 
3027     // Assume variable sized types are passed in memory.
3028     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
3029       return;
3030 
3031     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
3032 
3033     // Reset Lo class, this will be recomputed.
3034     Current = NoClass;
3035 
3036     // If this is a C++ record, classify the bases first.
3037     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
3038       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
3039         assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() &&
3040                "Unexpected base class!");
3041         const auto *Base =
3042             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3043 
3044         // Classify this field.
3045         //
3046         // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate exceeds a
3047         // single eightbyte, each is classified separately. Each eightbyte gets
3048         // initialized to class NO_CLASS.
3049         Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
3050         uint64_t Offset =
3051           OffsetBase + getContext().toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base));
3052         classify(I.getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
3053         Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
3054         Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
3055         if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) {
3056           postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
3057           return;
3058         }
3059       }
3060     }
3061 
3062     // Classify the fields one at a time, merging the results.
3063     unsigned idx = 0;
3064     bool UseClang11Compat = getContext().getLangOpts().getClangABICompat() <=
3065                                 LangOptions::ClangABI::Ver11 ||
3066                             getContext().getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPS4();
3067     bool IsUnion = RT->isUnionType() && !UseClang11Compat;
3068 
3069     for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
3070            i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
3071       uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
3072       bool BitField = i->isBitField();
3073 
3074       // Ignore padding bit-fields.
3075       if (BitField && i->isUnnamedBitfield())
3076         continue;
3077 
3078       // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger than
3079       // eight eightbytes, or it contains unaligned fields, it has class MEMORY.
3080       //
3081       // The only case a 256-bit or a 512-bit wide vector could be used is when
3082       // the struct contains a single 256-bit or 512-bit element. Early check
3083       // and fallback to memory.
3084       //
3085       // FIXME: Extended the Lo and Hi logic properly to work for size wider
3086       // than 128.
3087       if (Size > 128 &&
3088           ((!IsUnion && Size != getContext().getTypeSize(i->getType())) ||
3089            Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) {
3090         Lo = Memory;
3091         postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
3092         return;
3093       }
3094       // Note, skip this test for bit-fields, see below.
3095       if (!BitField && Offset % getContext().getTypeAlign(i->getType())) {
3096         Lo = Memory;
3097         postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
3098         return;
3099       }
3100 
3101       // Classify this field.
3102       //
3103       // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate
3104       // exceeds a single eightbyte, each is classified
3105       // separately. Each eightbyte gets initialized to class
3106       // NO_CLASS.
3107       Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
3108 
3109       // Bit-fields require special handling, they do not force the
3110       // structure to be passed in memory even if unaligned, and
3111       // therefore they can straddle an eightbyte.
3112       if (BitField) {
3113         assert(!i->isUnnamedBitfield());
3114         uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
3115         uint64_t Size = i->getBitWidthValue(getContext());
3116 
3117         uint64_t EB_Lo = Offset / 64;
3118         uint64_t EB_Hi = (Offset + Size - 1) / 64;
3119 
3120         if (EB_Lo) {
3121           assert(EB_Hi == EB_Lo && "Invalid classification, type > 16 bytes.");
3122           FieldLo = NoClass;
3123           FieldHi = Integer;
3124         } else {
3125           FieldLo = Integer;
3126           FieldHi = EB_Hi ? Integer : NoClass;
3127         }
3128       } else
3129         classify(i->getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
3130       Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
3131       Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
3132       if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory)
3133         break;
3134     }
3135 
3136     postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
3137   }
3138 }
3139 
3140 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const {
3141   // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right
3142   // place naturally.
3143   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
3144     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3145     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
3146       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3147 
3148     if (Ty->isExtIntType())
3149       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
3150 
3151     return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
3152                                               : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
3153   }
3154 
3155   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
3156 }
3157 
3158 bool X86_64ABIInfo::IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
3159   if (const VectorType *VecTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
3160     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VecTy);
3161     unsigned LargestVector = getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel);
3162     if (Size <= 64 || Size > LargestVector)
3163       return true;
3164     QualType EltTy = VecTy->getElementType();
3165     if (passInt128VectorsInMem() &&
3166         (EltTy->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Int128) ||
3167          EltTy->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::UInt128)))
3168       return true;
3169   }
3170 
3171   return false;
3172 }
3173 
3174 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty,
3175                                             unsigned freeIntRegs) const {
3176   // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right
3177   // place naturally.
3178   //
3179   // This assumption is optimistic, as there could be free registers available
3180   // when we need to pass this argument in memory, and LLVM could try to pass
3181   // the argument in the free register. This does not seem to happen currently,
3182   // but this code would be much safer if we could mark the argument with
3183   // 'onstack'. See PR12193.
3184   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !IsIllegalVectorType(Ty) &&
3185       !Ty->isExtIntType()) {
3186     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3187     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
3188       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3189 
3190     return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
3191                                               : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
3192   }
3193 
3194   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
3195     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
3196 
3197   // Compute the byval alignment. We specify the alignment of the byval in all
3198   // cases so that the mid-level optimizer knows the alignment of the byval.
3199   unsigned Align = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8, 8U);
3200 
3201   // Attempt to avoid passing indirect results using byval when possible. This
3202   // is important for good codegen.
3203   //
3204   // We do this by coercing the value into a scalar type which the backend can
3205   // handle naturally (i.e., without using byval).
3206   //
3207   // For simplicity, we currently only do this when we have exhausted all of the
3208   // free integer registers. Doing this when there are free integer registers
3209   // would require more care, as we would have to ensure that the coerced value
3210   // did not claim the unused register. That would require either reording the
3211   // arguments to the function (so that any subsequent inreg values came first),
3212   // or only doing this optimization when there were no following arguments that
3213   // might be inreg.
3214   //
3215   // We currently expect it to be rare (particularly in well written code) for
3216   // arguments to be passed on the stack when there are still free integer
3217   // registers available (this would typically imply large structs being passed
3218   // by value), so this seems like a fair tradeoff for now.
3219   //
3220   // We can revisit this if the backend grows support for 'onstack' parameter
3221   // attributes. See PR12193.
3222   if (freeIntRegs == 0) {
3223     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
3224 
3225     // If this type fits in an eightbyte, coerce it into the matching integral
3226     // type, which will end up on the stack (with alignment 8).
3227     if (Align == 8 && Size <= 64)
3228       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
3229                                                           Size));
3230   }
3231 
3232   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
3233 }
3234 
3235 /// The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in a full vector XMM/YMM
3236 /// register. Pick an LLVM IR type that will be passed as a vector register.
3237 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
3238   // Wrapper structs/arrays that only contain vectors are passed just like
3239   // vectors; strip them off if present.
3240   if (const Type *InnerTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
3241     Ty = QualType(InnerTy, 0);
3242 
3243   llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
3244   if (isa<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)) {
3245     // Don't pass vXi128 vectors in their native type, the backend can't
3246     // legalize them.
3247     if (passInt128VectorsInMem() &&
3248         cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy(128)) {
3249       // Use a vXi64 vector.
3250       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
3251       return llvm::FixedVectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()),
3252                                         Size / 64);
3253     }
3254 
3255     return IRType;
3256   }
3257 
3258   if (IRType->getTypeID() == llvm::Type::FP128TyID)
3259     return IRType;
3260 
3261   // We couldn't find the preferred IR vector type for 'Ty'.
3262   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
3263   assert((Size == 128 || Size == 256 || Size == 512) && "Invalid type found!");
3264 
3265 
3266   // Return a LLVM IR vector type based on the size of 'Ty'.
3267   return llvm::FixedVectorType::get(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()),
3268                                     Size / 64);
3269 }
3270 
3271 /// BitsContainNoUserData - Return true if the specified [start,end) bit range
3272 /// is known to either be off the end of the specified type or being in
3273 /// alignment padding.  The user type specified is known to be at most 128 bits
3274 /// in size, and have passed through X86_64ABIInfo::classify with a successful
3275 /// classification that put one of the two halves in the INTEGER class.
3276 ///
3277 /// It is conservatively correct to return false.
3278 static bool BitsContainNoUserData(QualType Ty, unsigned StartBit,
3279                                   unsigned EndBit, ASTContext &Context) {
3280   // If the bytes being queried are off the end of the type, there is no user
3281   // data hiding here.  This handles analysis of builtins, vectors and other
3282   // types that don't contain interesting padding.
3283   unsigned TySize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
3284   if (TySize <= StartBit)
3285     return true;
3286 
3287   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
3288     unsigned EltSize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(AT->getElementType());
3289     unsigned NumElts = (unsigned)AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
3290 
3291     // Check each element to see if the element overlaps with the queried range.
3292     for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
3293       // If the element is after the span we care about, then we're done..
3294       unsigned EltOffset = i*EltSize;
3295       if (EltOffset >= EndBit) break;
3296 
3297       unsigned EltStart = EltOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-EltOffset :0;
3298       if (!BitsContainNoUserData(AT->getElementType(), EltStart,
3299                                  EndBit-EltOffset, Context))
3300         return false;
3301     }
3302     // If it overlaps no elements, then it is safe to process as padding.
3303     return true;
3304   }
3305 
3306   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3307     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
3308     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
3309 
3310     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
3311     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
3312       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
3313         assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() &&
3314                "Unexpected base class!");
3315         const auto *Base =
3316             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3317 
3318         // If the base is after the span we care about, ignore it.
3319         unsigned BaseOffset = Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base));
3320         if (BaseOffset >= EndBit) continue;
3321 
3322         unsigned BaseStart = BaseOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-BaseOffset :0;
3323         if (!BitsContainNoUserData(I.getType(), BaseStart,
3324                                    EndBit-BaseOffset, Context))
3325           return false;
3326       }
3327     }
3328 
3329     // Verify that no field has data that overlaps the region of interest.  Yes
3330     // this could be sped up a lot by being smarter about queried fields,
3331     // however we're only looking at structs up to 16 bytes, so we don't care
3332     // much.
3333     unsigned idx = 0;
3334     for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
3335          i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
3336       unsigned FieldOffset = (unsigned)Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
3337 
3338       // If we found a field after the region we care about, then we're done.
3339       if (FieldOffset >= EndBit) break;
3340 
3341       unsigned FieldStart = FieldOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-FieldOffset :0;
3342       if (!BitsContainNoUserData(i->getType(), FieldStart, EndBit-FieldOffset,
3343                                  Context))
3344         return false;
3345     }
3346 
3347     // If nothing in this record overlapped the area of interest, then we're
3348     // clean.
3349     return true;
3350   }
3351 
3352   return false;
3353 }
3354 
3355 /// ContainsFloatAtOffset - Return true if the specified LLVM IR type has a
3356 /// float member at the specified offset.  For example, {int,{float}} has a
3357 /// float at offset 4.  It is conservatively correct for this routine to return
3358 /// false.
3359 static bool ContainsFloatAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3360                                   const llvm::DataLayout &TD) {
3361   // Base case if we find a float.
3362   if (IROffset == 0 && IRType->isFloatTy())
3363     return true;
3364 
3365   // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3366   if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) {
3367     const llvm::StructLayout *SL = TD.getStructLayout(STy);
3368     unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset);
3369     IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
3370     return ContainsFloatAtOffset(STy->getElementType(Elt), IROffset, TD);
3371   }
3372 
3373   // If this is an array, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3374   if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) {
3375     llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType();
3376     unsigned EltSize = TD.getTypeAllocSize(EltTy);
3377     IROffset -= IROffset/EltSize*EltSize;
3378     return ContainsFloatAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset, TD);
3379   }
3380 
3381   return false;
3382 }
3383 
3384 
3385 /// GetSSETypeAtOffset - Return a type that will be passed by the backend in the
3386 /// low 8 bytes of an XMM register, corresponding to the SSE class.
3387 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::
3388 GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3389                    QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const {
3390   // The only three choices we have are either double, <2 x float>, or float. We
3391   // pass as float if the last 4 bytes is just padding.  This happens for
3392   // structs that contain 3 floats.
3393   if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+32,
3394                             SourceOffset*8+64, getContext()))
3395     return llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext());
3396 
3397   // We want to pass as <2 x float> if the LLVM IR type contains a float at
3398   // offset+0 and offset+4.  Walk the LLVM IR type to find out if this is the
3399   // case.
3400   if (ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset, getDataLayout()) &&
3401       ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset+4, getDataLayout()))
3402     return llvm::FixedVectorType::get(llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()),
3403                                       2);
3404 
3405   return llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext());
3406 }
3407 
3408 
3409 /// GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset - The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in
3410 /// an 8-byte GPR.  This means that we either have a scalar or we are talking
3411 /// about the high or low part of an up-to-16-byte struct.  This routine picks
3412 /// the best LLVM IR type to represent this, which may be i64 or may be anything
3413 /// else that the backend will pass in a GPR that works better (e.g. i8, %foo*,
3414 /// etc).
3415 ///
3416 /// PrefType is an LLVM IR type that corresponds to (part of) the IR type for
3417 /// the source type.  IROffset is an offset in bytes into the LLVM IR type that
3418 /// the 8-byte value references.  PrefType may be null.
3419 ///
3420 /// SourceTy is the source-level type for the entire argument.  SourceOffset is
3421 /// an offset into this that we're processing (which is always either 0 or 8).
3422 ///
3423 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::
3424 GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3425                        QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const {
3426   // If we're dealing with an un-offset LLVM IR type, then it means that we're
3427   // returning an 8-byte unit starting with it.  See if we can safely use it.
3428   if (IROffset == 0) {
3429     // Pointers and int64's always fill the 8-byte unit.
3430     if ((isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && Has64BitPointers) ||
3431         IRType->isIntegerTy(64))
3432       return IRType;
3433 
3434     // If we have a 1/2/4-byte integer, we can use it only if the rest of the
3435     // goodness in the source type is just tail padding.  This is allowed to
3436     // kick in for struct {double,int} on the int, but not on
3437     // struct{double,int,int} because we wouldn't return the second int.  We
3438     // have to do this analysis on the source type because we can't depend on
3439     // unions being lowered a specific way etc.
3440     if (IRType->isIntegerTy(8) || IRType->isIntegerTy(16) ||
3441         IRType->isIntegerTy(32) ||
3442         (isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && !Has64BitPointers)) {
3443       unsigned BitWidth = isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) ? 32 :
3444           cast<llvm::IntegerType>(IRType)->getBitWidth();
3445 
3446       if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+BitWidth,
3447                                 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext()))
3448         return IRType;
3449     }
3450   }
3451 
3452   if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) {
3453     // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3454     const llvm::StructLayout *SL = getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy);
3455     if (IROffset < SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
3456       unsigned FieldIdx = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset);
3457       IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(FieldIdx);
3458 
3459       return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(STy->getElementType(FieldIdx), IROffset,
3460                                     SourceTy, SourceOffset);
3461     }
3462   }
3463 
3464   if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) {
3465     llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType();
3466     unsigned EltSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(EltTy);
3467     unsigned EltOffset = IROffset/EltSize*EltSize;
3468     return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset-EltOffset, SourceTy,
3469                                   SourceOffset);
3470   }
3471 
3472   // Okay, we don't have any better idea of what to pass, so we pass this in an
3473   // integer register that isn't too big to fit the rest of the struct.
3474   unsigned TySizeInBytes =
3475     (unsigned)getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(SourceTy).getQuantity();
3476 
3477   assert(TySizeInBytes != SourceOffset && "Empty field?");
3478 
3479   // It is always safe to classify this as an integer type up to i64 that
3480   // isn't larger than the structure.
3481   return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
3482                                 std::min(TySizeInBytes-SourceOffset, 8U)*8);
3483 }
3484 
3485 
3486 /// GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair - Given a high and low type that can ideally
3487 /// be used as elements of a two register pair to pass or return, return a
3488 /// first class aggregate to represent them.  For example, if the low part of
3489 /// a by-value argument should be passed as i32* and the high part as float,
3490 /// return {i32*, float}.
3491 static llvm::Type *
3492 GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(llvm::Type *Lo, llvm::Type *Hi,
3493                            const llvm::DataLayout &TD) {
3494   // In order to correctly satisfy the ABI, we need to the high part to start
3495   // at offset 8.  If the high and low parts we inferred are both 4-byte types
3496   // (e.g. i32 and i32) then the resultant struct type ({i32,i32}) won't have
3497   // the second element at offset 8.  Check for this:
3498   unsigned LoSize = (unsigned)TD.getTypeAllocSize(Lo);
3499   unsigned HiAlign = TD.getABITypeAlignment(Hi);
3500   unsigned HiStart = llvm::alignTo(LoSize, HiAlign);
3501   assert(HiStart != 0 && HiStart <= 8 && "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!");
3502 
3503   // To handle this, we have to increase the size of the low part so that the
3504   // second element will start at an 8 byte offset.  We can't increase the size
3505   // of the second element because it might make us access off the end of the
3506   // struct.
3507   if (HiStart != 8) {
3508     // There are usually two sorts of types the ABI generation code can produce
3509     // for the low part of a pair that aren't 8 bytes in size: float or
3510     // i8/i16/i32.  This can also include pointers when they are 32-bit (X32 and
3511     // NaCl).
3512     // Promote these to a larger type.
3513     if (Lo->isFloatTy())
3514       Lo = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(Lo->getContext());
3515     else {
3516       assert((Lo->isIntegerTy() || Lo->isPointerTy())
3517              && "Invalid/unknown lo type");
3518       Lo = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Lo->getContext());
3519     }
3520   }
3521 
3522   llvm::StructType *Result = llvm::StructType::get(Lo, Hi);
3523 
3524   // Verify that the second element is at an 8-byte offset.
3525   assert(TD.getStructLayout(Result)->getElementOffset(1) == 8 &&
3526          "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!");
3527   return Result;
3528 }
3529 
3530 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::
3531 classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
3532   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 1. Classify the return type with the
3533   // classification algorithm.
3534   X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi;
3535   classify(RetTy, 0, Lo, Hi, /*isNamedArg*/ true);
3536 
3537   // Check some invariants.
3538   assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification.");
3539   assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification.");
3540 
3541   llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr;
3542   switch (Lo) {
3543   case NoClass:
3544     if (Hi == NoClass)
3545       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
3546     // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType
3547     // null.
3548     assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) &&
3549            "Unknown missing lo part");
3550     break;
3551 
3552   case SSEUp:
3553   case X87Up:
3554     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word.");
3555 
3556     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 2. Types of class memory are returned via
3557     // hidden argument.
3558   case Memory:
3559     return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy);
3560 
3561     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 3. If the class is INTEGER, the next
3562     // available register of the sequence %rax, %rdx is used.
3563   case Integer:
3564     ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0);
3565 
3566     // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend
3567     // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes.
3568     if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) {
3569       // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3570       if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
3571         RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3572 
3573       if (RetTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
3574           isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy))
3575         return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy);
3576     }
3577     break;
3578 
3579     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 4. If the class is SSE, the next
3580     // available SSE register of the sequence %xmm0, %xmm1 is used.
3581   case SSE:
3582     ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0);
3583     break;
3584 
3585     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 6. If the class is X87, the value is
3586     // returned on the X87 stack in %st0 as 80-bit x87 number.
3587   case X87:
3588     ResType = llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext());
3589     break;
3590 
3591     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 8. If the class is COMPLEX_X87, the real
3592     // part of the value is returned in %st0 and the imaginary part in
3593     // %st1.
3594   case ComplexX87:
3595     assert(Hi == ComplexX87 && "Unexpected ComplexX87 classification.");
3596     ResType = llvm::StructType::get(llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()),
3597                                     llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()));
3598     break;
3599   }
3600 
3601   llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr;
3602   switch (Hi) {
3603     // Memory was handled previously and X87 should
3604     // never occur as a hi class.
3605   case Memory:
3606   case X87:
3607     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word.");
3608 
3609   case ComplexX87: // Previously handled.
3610   case NoClass:
3611     break;
3612 
3613   case Integer:
3614     HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3615     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3616       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3617     break;
3618   case SSE:
3619     HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3620     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3621       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3622     break;
3623 
3624     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 5. If the class is SSEUP, the eightbyte
3625     // is passed in the next available eightbyte chunk if the last used
3626     // vector register.
3627     //
3628     // SSEUP should always be preceded by SSE, just widen.
3629   case SSEUp:
3630     assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification.");
3631     ResType = GetByteVectorType(RetTy);
3632     break;
3633 
3634     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 7. If the class is X87UP, the value is
3635     // returned together with the previous X87 value in %st0.
3636   case X87Up:
3637     // If X87Up is preceded by X87, we don't need to do
3638     // anything. However, in some cases with unions it may not be
3639     // preceded by X87. In such situations we follow gcc and pass the
3640     // extra bits in an SSE reg.
3641     if (Lo != X87) {
3642       HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3643       if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3644         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3645     }
3646     break;
3647   }
3648 
3649   // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part.  It is
3650   // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result.  We do this by forming a
3651   // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high}
3652   if (HighPart)
3653     ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout());
3654 
3655   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
3656 }
3657 
3658 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(
3659   QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE,
3660   bool isNamedArg)
3661   const
3662 {
3663   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
3664 
3665   X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi;
3666   classify(Ty, 0, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg);
3667 
3668   // Check some invariants.
3669   // FIXME: Enforce these by construction.
3670   assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification.");
3671   assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification.");
3672 
3673   neededInt = 0;
3674   neededSSE = 0;
3675   llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr;
3676   switch (Lo) {
3677   case NoClass:
3678     if (Hi == NoClass)
3679       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
3680     // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType
3681     // null.
3682     assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) &&
3683            "Unknown missing lo part");
3684     break;
3685 
3686     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 1. If the class is MEMORY, pass the argument
3687     // on the stack.
3688   case Memory:
3689 
3690     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 5. If the class is X87, X87UP or
3691     // COMPLEX_X87, it is passed in memory.
3692   case X87:
3693   case ComplexX87:
3694     if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()) == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect)
3695       ++neededInt;
3696     return getIndirectResult(Ty, freeIntRegs);
3697 
3698   case SSEUp:
3699   case X87Up:
3700     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word.");
3701 
3702     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 2. If the class is INTEGER, the next
3703     // available register of the sequence %rdi, %rsi, %rdx, %rcx, %r8
3704     // and %r9 is used.
3705   case Integer:
3706     ++neededInt;
3707 
3708     // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type.
3709     ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 0, Ty, 0);
3710 
3711     // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend
3712     // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes.
3713     if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) {
3714       // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3715       if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
3716         Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3717 
3718       if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
3719           isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty))
3720         return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
3721     }
3722 
3723     break;
3724 
3725     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 3. If the class is SSE, the next
3726     // available SSE register is used, the registers are taken in the
3727     // order from %xmm0 to %xmm7.
3728   case SSE: {
3729     llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
3730     ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(IRType, 0, Ty, 0);
3731     ++neededSSE;
3732     break;
3733   }
3734   }
3735 
3736   llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr;
3737   switch (Hi) {
3738     // Memory was handled previously, ComplexX87 and X87 should
3739     // never occur as hi classes, and X87Up must be preceded by X87,
3740     // which is passed in memory.
3741   case Memory:
3742   case X87:
3743   case ComplexX87:
3744     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word.");
3745 
3746   case NoClass: break;
3747 
3748   case Integer:
3749     ++neededInt;
3750     // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type.
3751     HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8);
3752 
3753     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3754       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3755     break;
3756 
3757     // X87Up generally doesn't occur here (long double is passed in
3758     // memory), except in situations involving unions.
3759   case X87Up:
3760   case SSE:
3761     HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8);
3762 
3763     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3764       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3765 
3766     ++neededSSE;
3767     break;
3768 
3769     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 4. If the class is SSEUP, the
3770     // eightbyte is passed in the upper half of the last used SSE
3771     // register.  This only happens when 128-bit vectors are passed.
3772   case SSEUp:
3773     assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification");
3774     ResType = GetByteVectorType(Ty);
3775     break;
3776   }
3777 
3778   // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part.  It is
3779   // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result.  We do this by forming a
3780   // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high}
3781   if (HighPart)
3782     ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout());
3783 
3784   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
3785 }
3786 
3787 ABIArgInfo
3788 X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
3789                                              unsigned &NeededSSE) const {
3790   auto RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
3791   assert(RT && "classifyRegCallStructType only valid with struct types");
3792 
3793   if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
3794     return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3795 
3796   // Sum up bases
3797   if (auto CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) {
3798     if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) {
3799       NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3800       return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3801     }
3802 
3803     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
3804       if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(I.getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE)
3805               .isIndirect()) {
3806         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3807         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3808       }
3809   }
3810 
3811   // Sum up members
3812   for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) {
3813     if (FD->getType()->isRecordType() && !FD->getType()->isUnionType()) {
3814       if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(FD->getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE)
3815               .isIndirect()) {
3816         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3817         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3818       }
3819     } else {
3820       unsigned LocalNeededInt, LocalNeededSSE;
3821       if (classifyArgumentType(FD->getType(), UINT_MAX, LocalNeededInt,
3822                                LocalNeededSSE, true)
3823               .isIndirect()) {
3824         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3825         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3826       }
3827       NeededInt += LocalNeededInt;
3828       NeededSSE += LocalNeededSSE;
3829     }
3830   }
3831 
3832   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3833 }
3834 
3835 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty,
3836                                                     unsigned &NeededInt,
3837                                                     unsigned &NeededSSE) const {
3838 
3839   NeededInt = 0;
3840   NeededSSE = 0;
3841 
3842   return classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(Ty, NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3843 }
3844 
3845 void X86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
3846 
3847   const unsigned CallingConv = FI.getCallingConvention();
3848   // It is possible to force Win64 calling convention on any x86_64 target by
3849   // using __attribute__((ms_abi)). In such case to correctly emit Win64
3850   // compatible code delegate this call to WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo.
3851   if (CallingConv == llvm::CallingConv::Win64) {
3852     WinX86_64ABIInfo Win64ABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel);
3853     Win64ABIInfo.computeInfo(FI);
3854     return;
3855   }
3856 
3857   bool IsRegCall = CallingConv == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall;
3858 
3859   // Keep track of the number of assigned registers.
3860   unsigned FreeIntRegs = IsRegCall ? 11 : 6;
3861   unsigned FreeSSERegs = IsRegCall ? 16 : 8;
3862   unsigned NeededInt, NeededSSE;
3863 
3864   if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this)) {
3865     if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isRecordType() &&
3866         !FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isUnionType()) {
3867       FI.getReturnInfo() =
3868           classifyRegCallStructType(FI.getReturnType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3869       if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) {
3870         FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt;
3871         FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE;
3872       } else {
3873         FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType());
3874       }
3875     } else if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getAs<ComplexType>() &&
3876                getContext().getCanonicalType(FI.getReturnType()
3877                                                  ->getAs<ComplexType>()
3878                                                  ->getElementType()) ==
3879                    getContext().LongDoubleTy)
3880       // Complex Long Double Type is passed in Memory when Regcall
3881       // calling convention is used.
3882       FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType());
3883     else
3884       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
3885   }
3886 
3887   // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one
3888   // integer register.
3889   if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect())
3890     --FreeIntRegs;
3891 
3892   // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register.
3893   if (FI.isChainCall())
3894     ++FreeIntRegs;
3895 
3896   unsigned NumRequiredArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs();
3897   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Once arguments are classified, the registers
3898   // get assigned (in left-to-right order) for passing as follows...
3899   unsigned ArgNo = 0;
3900   for (CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator it = FI.arg_begin(), ie = FI.arg_end();
3901        it != ie; ++it, ++ArgNo) {
3902     bool IsNamedArg = ArgNo < NumRequiredArgs;
3903 
3904     if (IsRegCall && it->type->isStructureOrClassType())
3905       it->info = classifyRegCallStructType(it->type, NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3906     else
3907       it->info = classifyArgumentType(it->type, FreeIntRegs, NeededInt,
3908                                       NeededSSE, IsNamedArg);
3909 
3910     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: If there are no registers available for any
3911     // eightbyte of an argument, the whole argument is passed on the
3912     // stack. If registers have already been assigned for some
3913     // eightbytes of such an argument, the assignments get reverted.
3914     if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) {
3915       FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt;
3916       FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE;
3917     } else {
3918       it->info = getIndirectResult(it->type, FreeIntRegs);
3919     }
3920   }
3921 }
3922 
3923 static Address EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
3924                                          Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) {
3925   Address overflow_arg_area_p =
3926       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_p");
3927   llvm::Value *overflow_arg_area =
3928     CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(overflow_arg_area_p, "overflow_arg_area");
3929 
3930   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 7. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to a 16
3931   // byte boundary if alignment needed by type exceeds 8 byte boundary.
3932   // It isn't stated explicitly in the standard, but in practice we use
3933   // alignment greater than 16 where necessary.
3934   CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
3935   if (Align > CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)) {
3936     overflow_arg_area = emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, overflow_arg_area,
3937                                                       Align);
3938   }
3939 
3940   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 8. Fetch type from l->overflow_arg_area.
3941   llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
3942   llvm::Value *Res =
3943     CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(overflow_arg_area,
3944                               llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(LTy));
3945 
3946   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 9. Set l->overflow_arg_area to:
3947   // l->overflow_arg_area + sizeof(type).
3948   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 10. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to
3949   // an 8 byte boundary.
3950 
3951   uint64_t SizeInBytes = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 7) / 8;
3952   llvm::Value *Offset =
3953       llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (SizeInBytes + 7)  & ~7);
3954   overflow_arg_area = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(overflow_arg_area, Offset,
3955                                             "overflow_arg_area.next");
3956   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(overflow_arg_area, overflow_arg_area_p);
3957 
3958   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 11. Return the fetched type.
3959   return Address(Res, Align);
3960 }
3961 
3962 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
3963                                  QualType Ty) const {
3964   // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type:
3965   // struct {
3966   //   i32 gp_offset;
3967   //   i32 fp_offset;
3968   //   i8* overflow_arg_area;
3969   //   i8* reg_save_area;
3970   // };
3971   unsigned neededInt, neededSSE;
3972 
3973   Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty);
3974   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty, 0, neededInt, neededSSE,
3975                                        /*isNamedArg*/false);
3976 
3977   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 1. Determine whether type may be passed
3978   // in the registers. If not go to step 7.
3979   if (!neededInt && !neededSSE)
3980     return EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
3981 
3982   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 2. Compute num_gp to hold the number of
3983   // general purpose registers needed to pass type and num_fp to hold
3984   // the number of floating point registers needed.
3985 
3986   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 3. Verify whether arguments fit into
3987   // registers. In the case: l->gp_offset > 48 - num_gp * 8 or
3988   // l->fp_offset > 304 - num_fp * 16 go to step 7.
3989   //
3990   // NOTE: 304 is a typo, there are (6 * 8 + 8 * 16) = 176 bytes of
3991   // register save space).
3992 
3993   llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr;
3994   Address gp_offset_p = Address::invalid(), fp_offset_p = Address::invalid();
3995   llvm::Value *gp_offset = nullptr, *fp_offset = nullptr;
3996   if (neededInt) {
3997     gp_offset_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, "gp_offset_p");
3998     gp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(gp_offset_p, "gp_offset");
3999     InRegs = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 48 - neededInt * 8);
4000     InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(gp_offset, InRegs, "fits_in_gp");
4001   }
4002 
4003   if (neededSSE) {
4004     fp_offset_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 1, "fp_offset_p");
4005     fp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(fp_offset_p, "fp_offset");
4006     llvm::Value *FitsInFP =
4007       llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 176 - neededSSE * 16);
4008     FitsInFP = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(fp_offset, FitsInFP, "fits_in_fp");
4009     InRegs = InRegs ? CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(InRegs, FitsInFP) : FitsInFP;
4010   }
4011 
4012   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
4013   llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem");
4014   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
4015   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock);
4016 
4017   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers.
4018 
4019   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
4020 
4021   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 4. Fetch type from l->reg_save_area with
4022   // an offset of l->gp_offset and/or l->fp_offset. This may require
4023   // copying to a temporary location in case the parameter is passed
4024   // in different register classes or requires an alignment greater
4025   // than 8 for general purpose registers and 16 for XMM registers.
4026   //
4027   // FIXME: This really results in shameful code when we end up needing to
4028   // collect arguments from different places; often what should result in a
4029   // simple assembling of a structure from scattered addresses has many more
4030   // loads than necessary. Can we clean this up?
4031   llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
4032   llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
4033       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3), "reg_save_area");
4034 
4035   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
4036   if (neededInt && neededSSE) {
4037     // FIXME: Cleanup.
4038     assert(AI.isDirect() && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
4039     llvm::StructType *ST = cast<llvm::StructType>(AI.getCoerceToType());
4040     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
4041     Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST);
4042     assert(ST->getNumElements() == 2 && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
4043     llvm::Type *TyLo = ST->getElementType(0);
4044     llvm::Type *TyHi = ST->getElementType(1);
4045     assert((TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ^ TyHi->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) &&
4046            "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
4047     llvm::Type *PTyLo = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyLo);
4048     llvm::Type *PTyHi = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyHi);
4049     llvm::Value *GPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset);
4050     llvm::Value *FPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset);
4051     llvm::Value *RegLoAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? FPAddr : GPAddr;
4052     llvm::Value *RegHiAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? GPAddr : FPAddr;
4053 
4054     // Copy the first element.
4055     // FIXME: Our choice of alignment here and below is probably pessimistic.
4056     llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad(
4057         TyLo, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegLoAddr, PTyLo),
4058         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyLo)));
4059     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0));
4060 
4061     // Copy the second element.
4062     V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad(
4063         TyHi, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegHiAddr, PTyHi),
4064         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyHi)));
4065     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1));
4066 
4067     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy);
4068   } else if (neededInt) {
4069     RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset),
4070                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
4071     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy);
4072 
4073     // Copy to a temporary if necessary to ensure the appropriate alignment.
4074     auto TInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4075     uint64_t TySize = TInfo.Width.getQuantity();
4076     CharUnits TyAlign = TInfo.Align;
4077 
4078     // Copy into a temporary if the type is more aligned than the
4079     // register save area.
4080     if (TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
4081       Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
4082       CGF.Builder.CreateMemCpy(Tmp, RegAddr, TySize, false);
4083       RegAddr = Tmp;
4084     }
4085 
4086   } else if (neededSSE == 1) {
4087     RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset),
4088                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
4089     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy);
4090   } else {
4091     assert(neededSSE == 2 && "Invalid number of needed registers!");
4092     // SSE registers are spaced 16 bytes apart in the register save
4093     // area, we need to collect the two eightbytes together.
4094     // The ABI isn't explicit about this, but it seems reasonable
4095     // to assume that the slots are 16-byte aligned, since the stack is
4096     // naturally 16-byte aligned and the prologue is expected to store
4097     // all the SSE registers to the RSA.
4098     Address RegAddrLo = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset),
4099                                 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
4100     Address RegAddrHi =
4101       CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddrLo,
4102                                              CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
4103     llvm::Type *ST = AI.canHaveCoerceToType()
4104                          ? AI.getCoerceToType()
4105                          : llvm::StructType::get(CGF.DoubleTy, CGF.DoubleTy);
4106     llvm::Value *V;
4107     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
4108     Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST);
4109     V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(
4110         RegAddrLo, ST->getStructElementType(0)));
4111     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0));
4112     V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(
4113         RegAddrHi, ST->getStructElementType(1)));
4114     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1));
4115 
4116     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy);
4117   }
4118 
4119   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 5. Set:
4120   // l->gp_offset = l->gp_offset + num_gp * 8
4121   // l->fp_offset = l->fp_offset + num_fp * 16.
4122   if (neededInt) {
4123     llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededInt * 8);
4124     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(gp_offset, Offset),
4125                             gp_offset_p);
4126   }
4127   if (neededSSE) {
4128     llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededSSE * 16);
4129     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(fp_offset, Offset),
4130                             fp_offset_p);
4131   }
4132   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
4133 
4134   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory.
4135 
4136   CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock);
4137   Address MemAddr = EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
4138 
4139   // Return the appropriate result.
4140 
4141   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
4142   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, MemAddr, InMemBlock,
4143                                  "vaarg.addr");
4144   return ResAddr;
4145 }
4146 
4147 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4148                                    QualType Ty) const {
4149   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
4150                           CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
4151                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
4152                           /*allowHigherAlign*/ false);
4153 }
4154 
4155 ABIArgInfo
4156 WinX86_64ABIInfo::reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
4157                                     const ABIArgInfo &current) const {
4158   // Assumes vectorCall calling convention.
4159   const Type *Base = nullptr;
4160   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
4161 
4162   if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType() &&
4163       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts) && FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
4164     FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
4165     return getDirectX86Hva();
4166   }
4167   return current;
4168 }
4169 
4170 ABIArgInfo WinX86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
4171                                       bool IsReturnType, bool IsVectorCall,
4172                                       bool IsRegCall) const {
4173 
4174   if (Ty->isVoidType())
4175     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4176 
4177   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
4178     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
4179 
4180   TypeInfo Info = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty);
4181   uint64_t Width = Info.Width;
4182   CharUnits Align = getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align);
4183 
4184   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4185   if (RT) {
4186     if (!IsReturnType) {
4187       if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()))
4188         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
4189     }
4190 
4191     if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
4192       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
4193 
4194   }
4195 
4196   const Type *Base = nullptr;
4197   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
4198   // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar to
4199   // other targets.
4200   if ((IsVectorCall || IsRegCall) &&
4201       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
4202     if (IsRegCall) {
4203       if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
4204         FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
4205         if (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())
4206           return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4207         return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
4208       }
4209       return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
4210     } else if (IsVectorCall) {
4211       if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts &&
4212           (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())) {
4213         FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
4214         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4215       } else if (IsReturnType) {
4216         return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
4217       } else if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType()) {
4218         // HVAs are delayed and reclassified in the 2nd step.
4219         return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
4220       }
4221     }
4222   }
4223 
4224   if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4225     // If the member pointer is represented by an LLVM int or ptr, pass it
4226     // directly.
4227     llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
4228     if (LLTy->isPointerTy() || LLTy->isIntegerTy())
4229       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4230   }
4231 
4232   if (RT || Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4233     // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is
4234     // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference."
4235     if (Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
4236       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
4237 
4238     // Otherwise, coerce it to a small integer.
4239     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Width));
4240   }
4241 
4242   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4243     switch (BT->getKind()) {
4244     case BuiltinType::Bool:
4245       // Bool type is always extended to the ABI, other builtin types are not
4246       // extended.
4247       return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
4248 
4249     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
4250       // Mingw64 GCC uses the old 80 bit extended precision floating point
4251       // unit. It passes them indirectly through memory.
4252       if (IsMingw64) {
4253         const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
4254         if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended())
4255           return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
4256       }
4257       break;
4258 
4259     case BuiltinType::Int128:
4260     case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4261       // If it's a parameter type, the normal ABI rule is that arguments larger
4262       // than 8 bytes are passed indirectly. GCC follows it. We follow it too,
4263       // even though it isn't particularly efficient.
4264       if (!IsReturnType)
4265         return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
4266 
4267       // Mingw64 GCC returns i128 in XMM0. Coerce to v2i64 to handle that.
4268       // Clang matches them for compatibility.
4269       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::FixedVectorType::get(
4270           llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2));
4271 
4272     default:
4273       break;
4274     }
4275   }
4276 
4277   if (Ty->isExtIntType()) {
4278     // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is
4279     // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference."
4280     // However, non-power-of-two _ExtInts will be passed as 1,2,4 or 8 bytes
4281     // anyway as long is it fits in them, so we don't have to check the power of
4282     // 2.
4283     if (Width <= 64)
4284       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4285     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
4286   }
4287 
4288   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4289 }
4290 
4291 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI,
4292                                              unsigned FreeSSERegs,
4293                                              bool IsVectorCall,
4294                                              bool IsRegCall) const {
4295   unsigned Count = 0;
4296   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
4297     // Vectorcall in x64 only permits the first 6 arguments to be passed
4298     // as XMM/YMM registers.
4299     if (Count < VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg)
4300       I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
4301     else {
4302       // Since these cannot be passed in registers, pretend no registers
4303       // are left.
4304       unsigned ZeroSSERegsAvail = 0;
4305       I.info = classify(I.type, /*FreeSSERegs=*/ZeroSSERegsAvail, false,
4306                         IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
4307     }
4308     ++Count;
4309   }
4310 
4311   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
4312     I.info = reclassifyHvaArgType(I.type, FreeSSERegs, I.info);
4313   }
4314 }
4315 
4316 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
4317   const unsigned CC = FI.getCallingConvention();
4318   bool IsVectorCall = CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall;
4319   bool IsRegCall = CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall;
4320 
4321   // If __attribute__((sysv_abi)) is in use, use the SysV argument
4322   // classification rules.
4323   if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_64_SysV) {
4324     X86_64ABIInfo SysVABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel);
4325     SysVABIInfo.computeInfo(FI);
4326     return;
4327   }
4328 
4329   unsigned FreeSSERegs = 0;
4330   if (IsVectorCall) {
4331     // We can use up to 4 SSE return registers with vectorcall.
4332     FreeSSERegs = 4;
4333   } else if (IsRegCall) {
4334     // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers.
4335     FreeSSERegs = 16;
4336   }
4337 
4338   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4339     FI.getReturnInfo() = classify(FI.getReturnType(), FreeSSERegs, true,
4340                                   IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
4341 
4342   if (IsVectorCall) {
4343     // We can use up to 6 SSE register parameters with vectorcall.
4344     FreeSSERegs = 6;
4345   } else if (IsRegCall) {
4346     // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers, we can reuse the return registers.
4347     FreeSSERegs = 16;
4348   }
4349 
4350   if (IsVectorCall) {
4351     computeVectorCallArgs(FI, FreeSSERegs, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
4352   } else {
4353     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
4354       I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
4355   }
4356 
4357 }
4358 
4359 Address WinX86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4360                                     QualType Ty) const {
4361 
4362   bool IsIndirect = false;
4363 
4364   // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is
4365   // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference."
4366   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4367     uint64_t Width = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
4368     IsIndirect = Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width);
4369   }
4370 
4371   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect,
4372                           CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
4373                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
4374                           /*allowHigherAlign*/ false);
4375 }
4376 
4377 static bool PPC_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4378                                         llvm::Value *Address, bool Is64Bit,
4379                                         bool IsAIX) {
4380   // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified
4381   // against gcc output.  AFAIK all PPC ABIs use the same encoding.
4382 
4383   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
4384 
4385   llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty;
4386   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4);
4387   llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8);
4388   llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16);
4389 
4390   // 0-31: r0-31, the 4-byte or 8-byte general-purpose registers
4391   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Is64Bit ? Eight8 : Four8, 0, 31);
4392 
4393   // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers
4394   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63);
4395 
4396   // 64-67 are various 4-byte or 8-byte special-purpose registers:
4397   // 64: mq
4398   // 65: lr
4399   // 66: ctr
4400   // 67: ap
4401   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Is64Bit ? Eight8 : Four8, 64, 67);
4402 
4403   // 68-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers:
4404   // 68-75 cr0-7
4405   // 76: xer
4406   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 68, 76);
4407 
4408   // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers
4409   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108);
4410 
4411   // 109: vrsave
4412   // 110: vscr
4413   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Is64Bit ? Eight8 : Four8, 109, 110);
4414 
4415   // AIX does not utilize the rest of the registers.
4416   if (IsAIX)
4417     return false;
4418 
4419   // 111: spe_acc
4420   // 112: spefscr
4421   // 113: sfp
4422   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Is64Bit ? Eight8 : Four8, 111, 113);
4423 
4424   if (!Is64Bit)
4425     return false;
4426 
4427   // TODO: Need to verify if these registers are used on 64 bit AIX with Power8
4428   // or above CPU.
4429   // 64-bit only registers:
4430   // 114: tfhar
4431   // 115: tfiar
4432   // 116: texasr
4433   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 114, 116);
4434 
4435   return false;
4436 }
4437 
4438 // AIX
4439 namespace {
4440 /// AIXABIInfo - The AIX XCOFF ABI information.
4441 class AIXABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
4442   const bool Is64Bit;
4443   const unsigned PtrByteSize;
4444   CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const;
4445 
4446 public:
4447   AIXABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool Is64Bit)
4448       : ABIInfo(CGT), Is64Bit(Is64Bit), PtrByteSize(Is64Bit ? 8 : 4) {}
4449 
4450   bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const;
4451 
4452   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
4453   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
4454 
4455   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
4456     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4457       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
4458 
4459     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
4460       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
4461   }
4462 
4463   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4464                     QualType Ty) const override;
4465 };
4466 
4467 class AIXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
4468   const bool Is64Bit;
4469 
4470 public:
4471   AIXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool Is64Bit)
4472       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<AIXABIInfo>(CGT, Is64Bit)),
4473         Is64Bit(Is64Bit) {}
4474   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4475     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4476   }
4477 
4478   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4479                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4480 };
4481 } // namespace
4482 
4483 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero-
4484 // extended to 32/64 bits.
4485 bool AIXABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const {
4486   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
4487   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
4488     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
4489 
4490   // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI.
4491   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType())
4492     return true;
4493 
4494   if (!Is64Bit)
4495     return false;
4496 
4497   // For 64 bit mode, in addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also
4498   // need to extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64
4499   // bits.
4500   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
4501     switch (BT->getKind()) {
4502     case BuiltinType::Int:
4503     case BuiltinType::UInt:
4504       return true;
4505     default:
4506       break;
4507     }
4508 
4509   return false;
4510 }
4511 
4512 ABIArgInfo AIXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
4513   if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
4514     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4515 
4516   if (RetTy->isVectorType())
4517     llvm::report_fatal_error("vector type is not supported on AIX yet");
4518 
4519   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
4520     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4521 
4522   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy))
4523     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
4524 
4525   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
4526                                         : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4527 }
4528 
4529 ABIArgInfo AIXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
4530   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
4531 
4532   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
4533     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4534 
4535   if (Ty->isVectorType())
4536     llvm::report_fatal_error("vector type is not supported on AIX yet");
4537 
4538   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
4539     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
4540     // passed by value.
4541     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
4542       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
4543 
4544     CharUnits CCAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty);
4545     CharUnits TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
4546 
4547     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CCAlign, /*ByVal*/ true,
4548                                    /*Realign*/ TyAlign > CCAlign);
4549   }
4550 
4551   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
4552                                      : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4553 }
4554 
4555 CharUnits AIXABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const {
4556   // Complex types are passed just like their elements.
4557   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
4558     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
4559 
4560   if (Ty->isVectorType())
4561     llvm::report_fatal_error("vector type is not supported on AIX yet");
4562 
4563   // If the structure contains a vector type, the alignment is 16.
4564   if (isRecordWithSIMDVectorType(getContext(), Ty))
4565     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
4566 
4567   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(PtrByteSize);
4568 }
4569 
4570 Address AIXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4571                               QualType Ty) const {
4572   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
4573     llvm::report_fatal_error("complex type is not supported on AIX yet");
4574 
4575   if (Ty->isVectorType())
4576     llvm::report_fatal_error("vector type is not supported on AIX yet");
4577 
4578   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4579   TypeInfo.Align = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty);
4580 
4581   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(PtrByteSize);
4582 
4583   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false, TypeInfo,
4584                           SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true);
4585 }
4586 
4587 bool AIXTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(
4588     CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Value *Address) const {
4589   return PPC_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address, Is64Bit, /*IsAIX*/ true);
4590 }
4591 
4592 // PowerPC-32
4593 namespace {
4594 /// PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 32-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information.
4595 class PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
4596   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
4597   bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI;
4598 
4599   CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const;
4600 
4601 public:
4602   PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI,
4603                      bool RetSmallStructInRegABI)
4604       : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI),
4605         IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI) {}
4606 
4607   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
4608 
4609   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
4610     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4611       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
4612     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
4613       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
4614   }
4615 
4616   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4617                     QualType Ty) const override;
4618 };
4619 
4620 class PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
4621 public:
4622   PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI,
4623                          bool RetSmallStructInRegABI)
4624       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo>(
4625             CGT, SoftFloatABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI)) {}
4626 
4627   static bool isStructReturnInRegABI(const llvm::Triple &Triple,
4628                                      const CodeGenOptions &Opts);
4629 
4630   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4631     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4632     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4633   }
4634 
4635   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4636                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4637 };
4638 }
4639 
4640 CharUnits PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const {
4641   // Complex types are passed just like their elements.
4642   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
4643     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
4644 
4645   if (Ty->isVectorType())
4646     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16
4647                                                                        : 4);
4648 
4649   // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type
4650   // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element.
4651   const Type *AlignTy = nullptr;
4652   if (const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext())) {
4653     const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
4654     if ((EltType->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) ||
4655         (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint()))
4656       AlignTy = EltType;
4657   }
4658 
4659   if (AlignTy)
4660     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignTy->isVectorType() ? 16 : 4);
4661   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
4662 }
4663 
4664 ABIArgInfo PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
4665   uint64_t Size;
4666 
4667   // -msvr4-struct-return puts small aggregates in GPR3 and GPR4.
4668   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) && IsRetSmallStructInRegABI &&
4669       (Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy)) <= 64) {
4670     // System V ABI (1995), page 3-22, specified:
4671     // > A structure or union whose size is less than or equal to 8 bytes
4672     // > shall be returned in r3 and r4, as if it were first stored in the
4673     // > 8-byte aligned memory area and then the low addressed word were
4674     // > loaded into r3 and the high-addressed word into r4.  Bits beyond
4675     // > the last member of the structure or union are not defined.
4676     //
4677     // GCC for big-endian PPC32 inserts the pad before the first member,
4678     // not "beyond the last member" of the struct.  To stay compatible
4679     // with GCC, we coerce the struct to an integer of the same size.
4680     // LLVM will extend it and return i32 in r3, or i64 in r3:r4.
4681     if (Size == 0)
4682       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4683     else {
4684       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(getVMContext(), Size);
4685       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4686     }
4687   }
4688 
4689   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
4690 }
4691 
4692 // TODO: this implementation is now likely redundant with
4693 // DefaultABIInfo::EmitVAArg.
4694 Address PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAList,
4695                                       QualType Ty) const {
4696   if (getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) {
4697     auto TI = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4698     TI.Align = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty);
4699 
4700     CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
4701     return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAList, Ty,
4702                             classifyArgumentType(Ty).isIndirect(), TI, SlotSize,
4703                             /*AllowHigherAlign=*/true);
4704   }
4705 
4706   const unsigned OverflowLimit = 8;
4707   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
4708     // TODO: Implement this. For now ignore.
4709     (void)CTy;
4710     return Address::invalid(); // FIXME?
4711   }
4712 
4713   // struct __va_list_tag {
4714   //   unsigned char gpr;
4715   //   unsigned char fpr;
4716   //   unsigned short reserved;
4717   //   void *overflow_arg_area;
4718   //   void *reg_save_area;
4719   // };
4720 
4721   bool isI64 = Ty->isIntegerType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64;
4722   bool isInt =
4723       Ty->isIntegerType() || Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isAggregateType();
4724   bool isF64 = Ty->isFloatingType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64;
4725 
4726   // All aggregates are passed indirectly?  That doesn't seem consistent
4727   // with the argument-lowering code.
4728   bool isIndirect = Ty->isAggregateType();
4729 
4730   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
4731 
4732   // The calling convention either uses 1-2 GPRs or 1 FPR.
4733   Address NumRegsAddr = Address::invalid();
4734   if (isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) {
4735     NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 0, "gpr");
4736   } else {
4737     NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 1, "fpr");
4738   }
4739 
4740   llvm::Value *NumRegs = Builder.CreateLoad(NumRegsAddr, "numUsedRegs");
4741 
4742   // "Align" the register count when TY is i64.
4743   if (isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) {
4744     NumRegs = Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(1));
4745     NumRegs = Builder.CreateAnd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8((uint8_t) ~1U));
4746   }
4747 
4748   llvm::Value *CC =
4749       Builder.CreateICmpULT(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), "cond");
4750 
4751   llvm::BasicBlock *UsingRegs = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_regs");
4752   llvm::BasicBlock *UsingOverflow = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_overflow");
4753   llvm::BasicBlock *Cont = CGF.createBasicBlock("cont");
4754 
4755   Builder.CreateCondBr(CC, UsingRegs, UsingOverflow);
4756 
4757   llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
4758   if (isIndirect) DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0);
4759 
4760   // Case 1: consume registers.
4761   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
4762   {
4763     CGF.EmitBlock(UsingRegs);
4764 
4765     Address RegSaveAreaPtr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 4);
4766     RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr),
4767                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
4768     assert(RegAddr.getElementType() == CGF.Int8Ty);
4769 
4770     // Floating-point registers start after the general-purpose registers.
4771     if (!(isInt || IsSoftFloatABI)) {
4772       RegAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddr,
4773                                                    CharUnits::fromQuantity(32));
4774     }
4775 
4776     // Get the address of the saved value by scaling the number of
4777     // registers we've used by the number of
4778     CharUnits RegSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity((isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) ? 4 : 8);
4779     llvm::Value *RegOffset =
4780       Builder.CreateMul(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(RegSize.getQuantity()));
4781     RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(CGF.Int8Ty,
4782                                             RegAddr.getPointer(), RegOffset),
4783                       RegAddr.getAlignment().alignmentOfArrayElement(RegSize));
4784     RegAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, DirectTy);
4785 
4786     // Increase the used-register count.
4787     NumRegs =
4788       Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs,
4789                         Builder.getInt8((isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) ? 2 : 1));
4790     Builder.CreateStore(NumRegs, NumRegsAddr);
4791 
4792     CGF.EmitBranch(Cont);
4793   }
4794 
4795   // Case 2: consume space in the overflow area.
4796   Address MemAddr = Address::invalid();
4797   {
4798     CGF.EmitBlock(UsingOverflow);
4799 
4800     Builder.CreateStore(Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), NumRegsAddr);
4801 
4802     // Everything in the overflow area is rounded up to a size of at least 4.
4803     CharUnits OverflowAreaAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
4804 
4805     CharUnits Size;
4806     if (!isIndirect) {
4807       auto TypeInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4808       Size = TypeInfo.Width.alignTo(OverflowAreaAlign);
4809     } else {
4810       Size = CGF.getPointerSize();
4811     }
4812 
4813     Address OverflowAreaAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 3);
4814     Address OverflowArea(Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowAreaAddr, "argp.cur"),
4815                          OverflowAreaAlign);
4816     // Round up address of argument to alignment
4817     CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
4818     if (Align > OverflowAreaAlign) {
4819       llvm::Value *Ptr = OverflowArea.getPointer();
4820       OverflowArea = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, Align),
4821                                                            Align);
4822     }
4823 
4824     MemAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArea, DirectTy);
4825 
4826     // Increase the overflow area.
4827     OverflowArea = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OverflowArea, Size);
4828     Builder.CreateStore(OverflowArea.getPointer(), OverflowAreaAddr);
4829     CGF.EmitBranch(Cont);
4830   }
4831 
4832   CGF.EmitBlock(Cont);
4833 
4834   // Merge the cases with a phi.
4835   Address Result = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, UsingRegs, MemAddr, UsingOverflow,
4836                                 "vaarg.addr");
4837 
4838   // Load the pointer if the argument was passed indirectly.
4839   if (isIndirect) {
4840     Result = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Result, "aggr"),
4841                      getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty));
4842   }
4843 
4844   return Result;
4845 }
4846 
4847 bool PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(
4848     const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) {
4849   assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc);
4850 
4851   switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) {
4852   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default:
4853     break;
4854   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack: // -maix-struct-return
4855     return false;
4856   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs: // -msvr4-struct-return
4857     return true;
4858   }
4859 
4860   if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && !Triple.isOSLinux())
4861     return true;
4862 
4863   return false;
4864 }
4865 
4866 bool
4867 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4868                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
4869   return PPC_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address, /*Is64Bit*/ false,
4870                                      /*IsAIX*/ false);
4871 }
4872 
4873 // PowerPC-64
4874 
4875 namespace {
4876 /// PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 64-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information.
4877 class PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
4878 public:
4879   enum ABIKind {
4880     ELFv1 = 0,
4881     ELFv2
4882   };
4883 
4884 private:
4885   static const unsigned GPRBits = 64;
4886   ABIKind Kind;
4887   bool HasQPX;
4888   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
4889 
4890   // A vector of float or double will be promoted to <4 x f32> or <4 x f64> and
4891   // will be passed in a QPX register.
4892   bool IsQPXVectorTy(const Type *Ty) const {
4893     if (!HasQPX)
4894       return false;
4895 
4896     if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4897       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
4898       if (NumElements == 1)
4899         return false;
4900 
4901       if (VT->getElementType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) {
4902         if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 256)
4903           return true;
4904       } else if (VT->getElementType()->
4905                    isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) {
4906         if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128)
4907           return true;
4908       }
4909     }
4910 
4911     return false;
4912   }
4913 
4914   bool IsQPXVectorTy(QualType Ty) const {
4915     return IsQPXVectorTy(Ty.getTypePtr());
4916   }
4917 
4918 public:
4919   PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX,
4920                      bool SoftFloatABI)
4921       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind), HasQPX(HasQPX),
4922         IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {}
4923 
4924   bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const;
4925   CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const;
4926 
4927   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
4928   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
4929 
4930   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
4931   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
4932                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
4933 
4934   // TODO: We can add more logic to computeInfo to improve performance.
4935   // Example: For aggregate arguments that fit in a register, we could
4936   // use getDirectInReg (as is done below for structs containing a single
4937   // floating-point value) to avoid pushing them to memory on function
4938   // entry.  This would require changing the logic in PPCISelLowering
4939   // when lowering the parameters in the caller and args in the callee.
4940   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
4941     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4942       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
4943     for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
4944       // We rely on the default argument classification for the most part.
4945       // One exception:  An aggregate containing a single floating-point
4946       // or vector item must be passed in a register if one is available.
4947       const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(I.type, getContext());
4948       if (T) {
4949         const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
4950         if (IsQPXVectorTy(T) ||
4951             (T->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(T) == 128) ||
4952             (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) {
4953           QualType QT(T, 0);
4954           I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CGT.ConvertType(QT));
4955           continue;
4956         }
4957       }
4958       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
4959     }
4960   }
4961 
4962   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4963                     QualType Ty) const override;
4964 
4965   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
4966                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
4967     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
4968   }
4969 
4970   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
4971     return false;
4972   }
4973 };
4974 
4975 class PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
4976 
4977 public:
4978   PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT,
4979                                PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX,
4980                                bool SoftFloatABI)
4981       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo>(
4982             CGT, Kind, HasQPX, SoftFloatABI)) {}
4983 
4984   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4985     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4986     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4987   }
4988 
4989   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4990                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4991 };
4992 
4993 class PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo {
4994 public:
4995   PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {}
4996 
4997   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4998     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4999     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
5000   }
5001 
5002   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
5003                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
5004 };
5005 
5006 }
5007 
5008 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero-
5009 // extended to 64 bits.
5010 bool
5011 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const {
5012   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
5013   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
5014     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
5015 
5016   // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI.
5017   if (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty))
5018     return true;
5019 
5020   // In addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also need to
5021   // extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64 bits.
5022   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
5023     switch (BT->getKind()) {
5024     case BuiltinType::Int:
5025     case BuiltinType::UInt:
5026       return true;
5027     default:
5028       break;
5029     }
5030 
5031   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
5032     if (EIT->getNumBits() < 64)
5033       return true;
5034 
5035   return false;
5036 }
5037 
5038 /// isAlignedParamType - Determine whether a type requires 16-byte or
5039 /// higher alignment in the parameter area.  Always returns at least 8.
5040 CharUnits PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const {
5041   // Complex types are passed just like their elements.
5042   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
5043     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
5044 
5045   // Only vector types of size 16 bytes need alignment (larger types are
5046   // passed via reference, smaller types are not aligned).
5047   if (IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) {
5048     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 128)
5049       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
5050 
5051     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
5052   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
5053     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 : 8);
5054   }
5055 
5056   // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type
5057   // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element.
5058   const Type *AlignAsType = nullptr;
5059   const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext());
5060   if (EltType) {
5061     const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
5062     if (IsQPXVectorTy(EltType) || (EltType->isVectorType() &&
5063          getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) ||
5064         (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint()))
5065       AlignAsType = EltType;
5066   }
5067 
5068   // Likewise for ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates.
5069   const Type *Base = nullptr;
5070   uint64_t Members = 0;
5071   if (!AlignAsType && Kind == ELFv2 &&
5072       isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members))
5073     AlignAsType = Base;
5074 
5075   // With special case aggregates, only vector base types need alignment.
5076   if (AlignAsType && IsQPXVectorTy(AlignAsType)) {
5077     if (getContext().getTypeSize(AlignAsType) > 128)
5078       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
5079 
5080     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
5081   } else if (AlignAsType) {
5082     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignAsType->isVectorType() ? 16 : 8);
5083   }
5084 
5085   // Otherwise, we only need alignment for any aggregate type that
5086   // has an alignment requirement of >= 16 bytes.
5087   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 128) {
5088     if (HasQPX && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 256)
5089       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
5090     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
5091   }
5092 
5093   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
5094 }
5095 
5096 /// isHomogeneousAggregate - Return true if a type is an ELFv2 homogeneous
5097 /// aggregate.  Base is set to the base element type, and Members is set
5098 /// to the number of base elements.
5099 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *&Base,
5100                                      uint64_t &Members) const {
5101   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
5102     uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
5103     if (NElements == 0)
5104       return false;
5105     if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(AT->getElementType(), Base, Members))
5106       return false;
5107     Members *= NElements;
5108   } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
5109     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
5110     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
5111       return false;
5112 
5113     Members = 0;
5114 
5115     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
5116     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
5117       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
5118         // Ignore empty records.
5119         if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), I.getType(), true))
5120           continue;
5121 
5122         uint64_t FldMembers;
5123         if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(I.getType(), Base, FldMembers))
5124           return false;
5125 
5126         Members += FldMembers;
5127       }
5128     }
5129 
5130     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
5131       // Ignore (non-zero arrays of) empty records.
5132       QualType FT = FD->getType();
5133       while (const ConstantArrayType *AT =
5134              getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
5135         if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() == 0)
5136           return false;
5137         FT = AT->getElementType();
5138       }
5139       if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FT, true))
5140         continue;
5141 
5142       // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode.
5143       if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
5144           FD->isZeroLengthBitField(getContext()))
5145         continue;
5146 
5147       uint64_t FldMembers;
5148       if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(FD->getType(), Base, FldMembers))
5149         return false;
5150 
5151       Members = (RD->isUnion() ?
5152                  std::max(Members, FldMembers) : Members + FldMembers);
5153     }
5154 
5155     if (!Base)
5156       return false;
5157 
5158     // Ensure there is no padding.
5159     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) * Members !=
5160         getContext().getTypeSize(Ty))
5161       return false;
5162   } else {
5163     Members = 1;
5164     if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
5165       Members = 2;
5166       Ty = CT->getElementType();
5167     }
5168 
5169     // Most ABIs only support float, double, and some vector type widths.
5170     if (!isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(Ty))
5171       return false;
5172 
5173     // The base type must be the same for all members.  Types that
5174     // agree in both total size and mode (float vs. vector) are
5175     // treated as being equivalent here.
5176     const Type *TyPtr = Ty.getTypePtr();
5177     if (!Base) {
5178       Base = TyPtr;
5179       // If it's a non-power-of-2 vector, its size is already a power-of-2,
5180       // so make sure to widen it explicitly.
5181       if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5182         QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType();
5183         unsigned NumElements =
5184             getContext().getTypeSize(VT) / getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy);
5185         Base = getContext()
5186                    .getVectorType(EltTy, NumElements, VT->getVectorKind())
5187                    .getTypePtr();
5188       }
5189     }
5190 
5191     if (Base->isVectorType() != TyPtr->isVectorType() ||
5192         getContext().getTypeSize(Base) != getContext().getTypeSize(TyPtr))
5193       return false;
5194   }
5195   return Members > 0 && isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(Base, Members);
5196 }
5197 
5198 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
5199   // Homogeneous aggregates for ELFv2 must have base types of float,
5200   // double, long double, or 128-bit vectors.
5201   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5202     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
5203         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double ||
5204         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
5205         (getContext().getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() &&
5206           (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))) {
5207       if (IsSoftFloatABI)
5208         return false;
5209       return true;
5210     }
5211   }
5212   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5213     if (getContext().getTypeSize(VT) == 128 || IsQPXVectorTy(Ty))
5214       return true;
5215   }
5216   return false;
5217 }
5218 
5219 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(
5220     const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const {
5221   // Vector and fp128 types require one register, other floating point types
5222   // require one or two registers depending on their size.
5223   uint32_t NumRegs =
5224       ((getContext().getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() &&
5225           Base->isFloat128Type()) ||
5226         Base->isVectorType()) ? 1
5227                               : (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 63) / 64;
5228 
5229   // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 8 registers.
5230   return Members * NumRegs <= 8;
5231 }
5232 
5233 ABIArgInfo
5234 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
5235   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
5236 
5237   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
5238     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
5239 
5240   // Non-Altivec vector types are passed in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes)
5241   // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes).
5242   if (Ty->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) {
5243     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
5244     if (Size > 128)
5245       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
5246     else if (Size < 128) {
5247       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
5248       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5249     }
5250   }
5251 
5252   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
5253     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128)
5254       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
5255 
5256   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
5257     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
5258       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
5259 
5260     uint64_t ABIAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty).getQuantity();
5261     uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity();
5262 
5263     // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are passed as array types.
5264     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5265     uint64_t Members = 0;
5266     if (Kind == ELFv2 &&
5267         isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
5268       llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
5269       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members);
5270       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5271     }
5272 
5273     // If an aggregate may end up fully in registers, we do not
5274     // use the ByVal method, but pass the aggregate as array.
5275     // This is usually beneficial since we avoid forcing the
5276     // back-end to store the argument to memory.
5277     uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
5278     if (Bits > 0 && Bits <= 8 * GPRBits) {
5279       llvm::Type *CoerceTy;
5280 
5281       // Types up to 8 bytes are passed as integer type (which will be
5282       // properly aligned in the argument save area doubleword).
5283       if (Bits <= GPRBits)
5284         CoerceTy =
5285             llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8));
5286       // Larger types are passed as arrays, with the base type selected
5287       // according to the required alignment in the save area.
5288       else {
5289         uint64_t RegBits = ABIAlign * 8;
5290         uint64_t NumRegs = llvm::alignTo(Bits, RegBits) / RegBits;
5291         llvm::Type *RegTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), RegBits);
5292         CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(RegTy, NumRegs);
5293       }
5294 
5295       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5296     }
5297 
5298     // All other aggregates are passed ByVal.
5299     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign),
5300                                    /*ByVal=*/true,
5301                                    /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign);
5302   }
5303 
5304   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
5305                                      : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5306 }
5307 
5308 ABIArgInfo
5309 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
5310   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
5311     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5312 
5313   if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
5314     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
5315 
5316   // Non-Altivec vector types are returned in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes)
5317   // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes).
5318   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(RetTy)) {
5319     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
5320     if (Size > 128)
5321       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5322     else if (Size < 128) {
5323       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
5324       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5325     }
5326   }
5327 
5328   if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
5329     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128)
5330       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false);
5331 
5332   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
5333     // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are returned as array types.
5334     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5335     uint64_t Members = 0;
5336     if (Kind == ELFv2 &&
5337         isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) {
5338       llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
5339       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members);
5340       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5341     }
5342 
5343     // ELFv2 small aggregates are returned in up to two registers.
5344     uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
5345     if (Kind == ELFv2 && Bits <= 2 * GPRBits) {
5346       if (Bits == 0)
5347         return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5348 
5349       llvm::Type *CoerceTy;
5350       if (Bits > GPRBits) {
5351         CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), GPRBits);
5352         CoerceTy = llvm::StructType::get(CoerceTy, CoerceTy);
5353       } else
5354         CoerceTy =
5355             llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8));
5356       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5357     }
5358 
5359     // All other aggregates are returned indirectly.
5360     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5361   }
5362 
5363   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
5364                                         : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5365 }
5366 
5367 // Based on ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg, adjusted for 64-bit machine.
5368 Address PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
5369                                       QualType Ty) const {
5370   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
5371   TypeInfo.Align = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty);
5372 
5373   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
5374 
5375   // If we have a complex type and the base type is smaller than 8 bytes,
5376   // the ABI calls for the real and imaginary parts to be right-adjusted
5377   // in separate doublewords.  However, Clang expects us to produce a
5378   // pointer to a structure with the two parts packed tightly.  So generate
5379   // loads of the real and imaginary parts relative to the va_list pointer,
5380   // and store them to a temporary structure.
5381   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
5382     CharUnits EltSize = TypeInfo.Width / 2;
5383     if (EltSize < SlotSize) {
5384       Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, CGF.Int8Ty,
5385                                             SlotSize * 2, SlotSize,
5386                                             SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true);
5387 
5388       Address RealAddr = Addr;
5389       Address ImagAddr = RealAddr;
5390       if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) {
5391         RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr,
5392                                                           SlotSize - EltSize);
5393         ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(ImagAddr,
5394                                                       2 * SlotSize - EltSize);
5395       } else {
5396         ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, SlotSize);
5397       }
5398 
5399       llvm::Type *EltTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(CTy->getElementType());
5400       RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RealAddr, EltTy);
5401       ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(ImagAddr, EltTy);
5402       llvm::Value *Real = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RealAddr, ".vareal");
5403       llvm::Value *Imag = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ImagAddr, ".vaimag");
5404 
5405       Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "vacplx");
5406       CGF.EmitStoreOfComplex({Real, Imag}, CGF.MakeAddrLValue(Temp, Ty),
5407                              /*init*/ true);
5408       return Temp;
5409     }
5410   }
5411 
5412   // Otherwise, just use the general rule.
5413   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false,
5414                           TypeInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true);
5415 }
5416 
5417 bool
5418 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(
5419   CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
5420   llvm::Value *Address) const {
5421   return PPC_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address, /*Is64Bit*/ true,
5422                                      /*IsAIX*/ false);
5423 }
5424 
5425 bool
5426 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
5427                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
5428   return PPC_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address, /*Is64Bit*/ true,
5429                                      /*IsAIX*/ false);
5430 }
5431 
5432 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5433 // AArch64 ABI Implementation
5434 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5435 
5436 namespace {
5437 
5438 class AArch64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
5439 public:
5440   enum ABIKind {
5441     AAPCS = 0,
5442     DarwinPCS,
5443     Win64
5444   };
5445 
5446 private:
5447   ABIKind Kind;
5448 
5449 public:
5450   AArch64ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind)
5451     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {}
5452 
5453 private:
5454   ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; }
5455   bool isDarwinPCS() const { return Kind == DarwinPCS; }
5456 
5457   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool IsVariadic) const;
5458   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
5459   ABIArgInfo coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const;
5460   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
5461   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
5462                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
5463 
5464   bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
5465 
5466   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
5467     if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this))
5468       FI.getReturnInfo() =
5469           classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic());
5470 
5471     for (auto &it : FI.arguments())
5472       it.info = classifyArgumentType(it.type);
5473   }
5474 
5475   Address EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
5476                           CodeGenFunction &CGF) const;
5477 
5478   Address EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
5479                          CodeGenFunction &CGF) const;
5480 
5481   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
5482                     QualType Ty) const override {
5483     llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
5484     if (isa<llvm::ScalableVectorType>(BaseTy))
5485       llvm::report_fatal_error("Passing SVE types to variadic functions is "
5486                                "currently not supported");
5487 
5488     return Kind == Win64 ? EmitMSVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty)
5489                          : isDarwinPCS() ? EmitDarwinVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF)
5490                                          : EmitAAPCSVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF);
5491   }
5492 
5493   Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
5494                       QualType Ty) const override;
5495 
5496   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
5497                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
5498     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
5499   }
5500   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
5501     return true;
5502   }
5503 
5504   bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy,
5505                                  unsigned elts) const override;
5506 
5507   bool allowBFloatArgsAndRet() const override {
5508     return getTarget().hasBFloat16Type();
5509   }
5510 };
5511 
5512 class AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
5513 public:
5514   AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind)
5515       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<AArch64ABIInfo>(CGT, Kind)) {}
5516 
5517   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
5518     return "mov\tfp, fp\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
5519   }
5520 
5521   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
5522     return 31;
5523   }
5524 
5525   bool doesReturnSlotInterfereWithArgs() const override { return false; }
5526 
5527   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
5528                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
5529     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
5530     if (!FD)
5531       return;
5532 
5533     const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
5534     if (TA == nullptr)
5535       return;
5536 
5537     ParsedTargetAttr Attr = TA->parse();
5538     if (Attr.BranchProtection.empty())
5539       return;
5540 
5541     TargetInfo::BranchProtectionInfo BPI;
5542     StringRef Error;
5543     (void)CGM.getTarget().validateBranchProtection(Attr.BranchProtection,
5544                                                    BPI, Error);
5545     assert(Error.empty());
5546 
5547     auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
5548     static const char *SignReturnAddrStr[] = {"none", "non-leaf", "all"};
5549     Fn->addFnAttr("sign-return-address", SignReturnAddrStr[static_cast<int>(BPI.SignReturnAddr)]);
5550 
5551     if (BPI.SignReturnAddr != LangOptions::SignReturnAddressScopeKind::None) {
5552       Fn->addFnAttr("sign-return-address-key",
5553                     BPI.SignKey == LangOptions::SignReturnAddressKeyKind::AKey
5554                         ? "a_key"
5555                         : "b_key");
5556     }
5557 
5558     Fn->addFnAttr("branch-target-enforcement",
5559                   BPI.BranchTargetEnforcement ? "true" : "false");
5560   }
5561 };
5562 
5563 class WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo {
5564 public:
5565   WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind K)
5566       : AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {}
5567 
5568   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
5569                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
5570 
5571   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
5572                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
5573     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
5574   }
5575 
5576   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value,
5577                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
5578     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
5579   }
5580 };
5581 
5582 void WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
5583     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
5584   AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
5585   if (GV->isDeclaration())
5586     return;
5587   addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
5588 }
5589 }
5590 
5591 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const {
5592   assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "expected vector type!");
5593 
5594   const auto *VT = Ty->castAs<VectorType>();
5595   if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector) {
5596     assert(VT->getElementType()->isBuiltinType() && "expected builtin type!");
5597     assert(VT->getElementType()->castAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind() ==
5598                BuiltinType::UChar &&
5599            "unexpected builtin type for SVE predicate!");
5600     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5601         llvm::Type::getInt1Ty(getVMContext()), 16));
5602   }
5603 
5604   if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector) {
5605     assert(VT->getElementType()->isBuiltinType() && "expected builtin type!");
5606 
5607     const auto *BT = VT->getElementType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5608     llvm::ScalableVectorType *ResType = nullptr;
5609     switch (BT->getKind()) {
5610     default:
5611       llvm_unreachable("unexpected builtin type for SVE vector!");
5612     case BuiltinType::SChar:
5613     case BuiltinType::UChar:
5614       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5615           llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()), 16);
5616       break;
5617     case BuiltinType::Short:
5618     case BuiltinType::UShort:
5619       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5620           llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()), 8);
5621       break;
5622     case BuiltinType::Int:
5623     case BuiltinType::UInt:
5624       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5625           llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4);
5626       break;
5627     case BuiltinType::Long:
5628     case BuiltinType::ULong:
5629       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5630           llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2);
5631       break;
5632     case BuiltinType::Half:
5633       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5634           llvm::Type::getHalfTy(getVMContext()), 8);
5635       break;
5636     case BuiltinType::Float:
5637       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5638           llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()), 4);
5639       break;
5640     case BuiltinType::Double:
5641       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5642           llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()), 2);
5643       break;
5644     case BuiltinType::BFloat16:
5645       ResType = llvm::ScalableVectorType::get(
5646           llvm::Type::getBFloatTy(getVMContext()), 8);
5647       break;
5648     }
5649     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5650   }
5651 
5652   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
5653   // Android promotes <2 x i8> to i16, not i32
5654   if (isAndroid() && (Size <= 16)) {
5655     llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext());
5656     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5657   }
5658   if (Size <= 32) {
5659     llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5660     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5661   }
5662   if (Size == 64) {
5663     auto *ResType =
5664         llvm::FixedVectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2);
5665     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5666   }
5667   if (Size == 128) {
5668     auto *ResType =
5669         llvm::FixedVectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4);
5670     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5671   }
5672   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
5673 }
5674 
5675 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
5676   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
5677 
5678   // Handle illegal vector types here.
5679   if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty))
5680     return coerceIllegalVector(Ty);
5681 
5682   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
5683     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
5684     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
5685       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
5686 
5687     if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
5688       if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128)
5689         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
5690 
5691     return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) && isDarwinPCS()
5692                 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
5693                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5694   }
5695 
5696   // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial
5697   // copy constructor are always indirect.
5698   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
5699     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA ==
5700                                      CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
5701   }
5702 
5703   // Empty records are always ignored on Darwin, but actually passed in C++ mode
5704   // elsewhere for GNU compatibility.
5705   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
5706   bool IsEmpty = isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true);
5707   if (IsEmpty || Size == 0) {
5708     if (!getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isDarwinPCS())
5709       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5710 
5711     // GNU C mode. The only argument that gets ignored is an empty one with size
5712     // 0.
5713     if (IsEmpty && Size == 0)
5714       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5715     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
5716   }
5717 
5718   // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) need to be expanded.
5719   const Type *Base = nullptr;
5720   uint64_t Members = 0;
5721   if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
5722     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
5723         llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members));
5724   }
5725 
5726   // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are passed directly in registers or on the stack.
5727   if (Size <= 128) {
5728     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of
5729     // same size and alignment.
5730     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
5731       return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext());
5732     }
5733     unsigned Alignment;
5734     if (Kind == AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS) {
5735       Alignment = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlign(Ty);
5736       Alignment = Alignment < 128 ? 64 : 128;
5737     } else {
5738       Alignment = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty),
5739                            (unsigned)getTarget().getPointerWidth(0));
5740     }
5741     Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, Alignment);
5742 
5743     // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment.
5744     // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128.
5745     llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(getVMContext(), Alignment);
5746     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
5747         Size == Alignment ? BaseTy
5748                           : llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / Alignment));
5749   }
5750 
5751   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
5752 }
5753 
5754 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy,
5755                                               bool IsVariadic) const {
5756   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
5757     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5758 
5759   if (const auto *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5760     if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector ||
5761         VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector)
5762       return coerceIllegalVector(RetTy);
5763   }
5764 
5765   // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
5766   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128)
5767     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5768 
5769   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
5770     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
5771     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
5772       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
5773 
5774     if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
5775       if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128)
5776         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5777 
5778     return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) && isDarwinPCS()
5779                 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
5780                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5781   }
5782 
5783   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
5784   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true) || Size == 0)
5785     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5786 
5787   const Type *Base = nullptr;
5788   uint64_t Members = 0;
5789   if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members) &&
5790       !(getTarget().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64_32 &&
5791         IsVariadic))
5792     // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) are returned directly.
5793     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
5794 
5795   // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are returned directly in registers or on the stack.
5796   if (Size <= 128) {
5797     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of
5798     // same size and alignment.
5799     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
5800       return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext());
5801     }
5802     unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(RetTy);
5803     Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes
5804 
5805     // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment.
5806     // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128.
5807     if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) {
5808       llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext());
5809       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64));
5810     }
5811     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size));
5812   }
5813 
5814   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5815 }
5816 
5817 /// isIllegalVectorType - check whether the vector type is legal for AArch64.
5818 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
5819   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5820     // Check whether VT is a fixed-length SVE vector. These types are
5821     // represented as scalable vectors in function args/return and must be
5822     // coerced from fixed vectors.
5823     if (VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthDataVector ||
5824         VT->getVectorKind() == VectorType::SveFixedLengthPredicateVector)
5825       return true;
5826 
5827     // Check whether VT is legal.
5828     unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
5829     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5830     // NumElements should be power of 2.
5831     if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements))
5832       return true;
5833 
5834     // arm64_32 has to be compatible with the ARM logic here, which allows huge
5835     // vectors for some reason.
5836     llvm::Triple Triple = getTarget().getTriple();
5837     if (Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::aarch64_32 &&
5838         Triple.isOSBinFormatMachO())
5839       return Size <= 32;
5840 
5841     return Size != 64 && (Size != 128 || NumElements == 1);
5842   }
5843   return false;
5844 }
5845 
5846 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
5847                                                llvm::Type *eltTy,
5848                                                unsigned elts) const {
5849   if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(elts))
5850     return false;
5851   if (totalSize.getQuantity() != 8 &&
5852       (totalSize.getQuantity() != 16 || elts == 1))
5853     return false;
5854   return true;
5855 }
5856 
5857 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
5858   // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS64 must have base types of a floating
5859   // point type or a short-vector type. This is the same as the 32-bit ABI,
5860   // but with the difference that any floating-point type is allowed,
5861   // including __fp16.
5862   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5863     if (BT->isFloatingPoint())
5864       return true;
5865   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5866     unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5867     if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128)
5868       return true;
5869   }
5870   return false;
5871 }
5872 
5873 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
5874                                                        uint64_t Members) const {
5875   return Members <= 4;
5876 }
5877 
5878 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr,
5879                                             QualType Ty,
5880                                             CodeGenFunction &CGF) const {
5881   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
5882   bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect();
5883 
5884   llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
5885   if (IsIndirect)
5886     BaseTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(BaseTy);
5887   else if (AI.getCoerceToType())
5888     BaseTy = AI.getCoerceToType();
5889 
5890   unsigned NumRegs = 1;
5891   if (llvm::ArrayType *ArrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(BaseTy)) {
5892     BaseTy = ArrTy->getElementType();
5893     NumRegs = ArrTy->getNumElements();
5894   }
5895   bool IsFPR = BaseTy->isFloatingPointTy() || BaseTy->isVectorTy();
5896 
5897   // The AArch64 va_list type and handling is specified in the Procedure Call
5898   // Standard, section B.4:
5899   //
5900   // struct {
5901   //   void *__stack;
5902   //   void *__gr_top;
5903   //   void *__vr_top;
5904   //   int __gr_offs;
5905   //   int __vr_offs;
5906   // };
5907 
5908   llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg");
5909   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
5910   llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack");
5911   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
5912 
5913   CharUnits TySize = getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty);
5914   CharUnits TyAlign = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(Ty);
5915 
5916   Address reg_offs_p = Address::invalid();
5917   llvm::Value *reg_offs = nullptr;
5918   int reg_top_index;
5919   int RegSize = IsIndirect ? 8 : TySize.getQuantity();
5920   if (!IsFPR) {
5921     // 3 is the field number of __gr_offs
5922     reg_offs_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, "gr_offs_p");
5923     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "gr_offs");
5924     reg_top_index = 1; // field number for __gr_top
5925     RegSize = llvm::alignTo(RegSize, 8);
5926   } else {
5927     // 4 is the field number of __vr_offs.
5928     reg_offs_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 4, "vr_offs_p");
5929     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "vr_offs");
5930     reg_top_index = 2; // field number for __vr_top
5931     RegSize = 16 * NumRegs;
5932   }
5933 
5934   //=======================================
5935   // Find out where argument was passed
5936   //=======================================
5937 
5938   // If reg_offs >= 0 we're already using the stack for this type of
5939   // argument. We don't want to keep updating reg_offs (in case it overflows,
5940   // though anyone passing 2GB of arguments, each at most 16 bytes, deserves
5941   // whatever they get).
5942   llvm::Value *UsingStack = nullptr;
5943   UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGE(
5944       reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0));
5945 
5946   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, MaybeRegBlock);
5947 
5948   // Otherwise, at least some kind of argument could go in these registers, the
5949   // question is whether this particular type is too big.
5950   CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock);
5951 
5952   // Integer arguments may need to correct register alignment (for example a
5953   // "struct { __int128 a; };" gets passed in x_2N, x_{2N+1}). In this case we
5954   // align __gr_offs to calculate the potential address.
5955   if (!IsFPR && !IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
5956     int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity();
5957 
5958     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
5959         reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Align - 1),
5960         "align_regoffs");
5961     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(
5962         reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -Align),
5963         "aligned_regoffs");
5964   }
5965 
5966   // Update the gr_offs/vr_offs pointer for next call to va_arg on this va_list.
5967   // The fact that this is done unconditionally reflects the fact that
5968   // allocating an argument to the stack also uses up all the remaining
5969   // registers of the appropriate kind.
5970   llvm::Value *NewOffset = nullptr;
5971   NewOffset = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
5972       reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, RegSize), "new_reg_offs");
5973   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOffset, reg_offs_p);
5974 
5975   // Now we're in a position to decide whether this argument really was in
5976   // registers or not.
5977   llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr;
5978   InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSLE(
5979       NewOffset, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0), "inreg");
5980 
5981   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, OnStackBlock);
5982 
5983   //=======================================
5984   // Argument was in registers
5985   //=======================================
5986 
5987   // Now we emit the code for if the argument was originally passed in
5988   // registers. First start the appropriate block:
5989   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
5990 
5991   llvm::Value *reg_top = nullptr;
5992   Address reg_top_p =
5993       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, reg_top_index, "reg_top_p");
5994   reg_top = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_top_p, "reg_top");
5995   Address BaseAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(reg_top, reg_offs),
5996                    CharUnits::fromQuantity(IsFPR ? 16 : 8));
5997   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
5998   llvm::Type *MemTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
5999 
6000   if (IsIndirect) {
6001     // If it's been passed indirectly (actually a struct), whatever we find from
6002     // stored registers or on the stack will actually be a struct **.
6003     MemTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(MemTy);
6004   }
6005 
6006   const Type *Base = nullptr;
6007   uint64_t NumMembers = 0;
6008   bool IsHFA = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumMembers);
6009   if (IsHFA && NumMembers > 1) {
6010     // Homogeneous aggregates passed in registers will have their elements split
6011     // and stored 16-bytes apart regardless of size (they're notionally in qN,
6012     // qN+1, ...). We reload and store into a temporary local variable
6013     // contiguously.
6014     assert(!IsIndirect && "Homogeneous aggregates should be passed directly");
6015     auto BaseTyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(QualType(Base, 0));
6016     llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
6017     llvm::Type *HFATy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, NumMembers);
6018     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateTempAlloca(HFATy,
6019                                        std::max(TyAlign, BaseTyInfo.Align));
6020 
6021     // On big-endian platforms, the value will be right-aligned in its slot.
6022     int Offset = 0;
6023     if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() &&
6024         BaseTyInfo.Width.getQuantity() < 16)
6025       Offset = 16 - BaseTyInfo.Width.getQuantity();
6026 
6027     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumMembers; ++i) {
6028       CharUnits BaseOffset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16 * i + Offset);
6029       Address LoadAddr =
6030         CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, BaseOffset);
6031       LoadAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(LoadAddr, BaseTy);
6032 
6033       Address StoreAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstArrayGEP(Tmp, i);
6034 
6035       llvm::Value *Elem = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(LoadAddr);
6036       CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Elem, StoreAddr);
6037     }
6038 
6039     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, MemTy);
6040   } else {
6041     // Otherwise the object is contiguous in memory.
6042 
6043     // It might be right-aligned in its slot.
6044     CharUnits SlotSize = BaseAddr.getAlignment();
6045     if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !IsIndirect &&
6046         (IsHFA || !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) &&
6047         TySize < SlotSize) {
6048       CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TySize;
6049       BaseAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, Offset);
6050     }
6051 
6052     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(BaseAddr, MemTy);
6053   }
6054 
6055   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
6056 
6057   //=======================================
6058   // Argument was on the stack
6059   //=======================================
6060   CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock);
6061 
6062   Address stack_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, "stack_p");
6063   llvm::Value *OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(stack_p, "stack");
6064 
6065   // Again, stack arguments may need realignment. In this case both integer and
6066   // floating-point ones might be affected.
6067   if (!IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
6068     int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity();
6069 
6070     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int64Ty);
6071 
6072     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
6073         OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1),
6074         "align_stack");
6075     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(
6076         OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, -Align),
6077         "align_stack");
6078 
6079     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int8PtrTy);
6080   }
6081   Address OnStackAddr(OnStackPtr,
6082                       std::max(CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), TyAlign));
6083 
6084   // All stack slots are multiples of 8 bytes.
6085   CharUnits StackSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
6086   CharUnits StackSize;
6087   if (IsIndirect)
6088     StackSize = StackSlotSize;
6089   else
6090     StackSize = TySize.alignTo(StackSlotSize);
6091 
6092   llvm::Value *StackSizeC = CGF.Builder.getSize(StackSize);
6093   llvm::Value *NewStack =
6094       CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(OnStackPtr, StackSizeC, "new_stack");
6095 
6096   // Write the new value of __stack for the next call to va_arg
6097   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewStack, stack_p);
6098 
6099   if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) &&
6100       TySize < StackSlotSize) {
6101     CharUnits Offset = StackSlotSize - TySize;
6102     OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OnStackAddr, Offset);
6103   }
6104 
6105   OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OnStackAddr, MemTy);
6106 
6107   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
6108 
6109   //=======================================
6110   // Tidy up
6111   //=======================================
6112   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
6113 
6114   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock,
6115                                  OnStackAddr, OnStackBlock, "vaargs.addr");
6116 
6117   if (IsIndirect)
6118     return Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "vaarg.addr"),
6119                    TyAlign);
6120 
6121   return ResAddr;
6122 }
6123 
6124 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
6125                                         CodeGenFunction &CGF) const {
6126   // The backend's lowering doesn't support va_arg for aggregates or
6127   // illegal vector types.  Lower VAArg here for these cases and use
6128   // the LLVM va_arg instruction for everything else.
6129   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !isIllegalVectorType(Ty))
6130     return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6131 
6132   uint64_t PointerSize = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0) / 8;
6133   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(PointerSize);
6134 
6135   // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes.
6136   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) {
6137     Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize);
6138     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
6139     return Addr;
6140   }
6141 
6142   // The size of the actual thing passed, which might end up just
6143   // being a pointer for indirect types.
6144   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
6145 
6146   // Arguments bigger than 16 bytes which aren't homogeneous
6147   // aggregates should be passed indirectly.
6148   bool IsIndirect = false;
6149   if (TyInfo.Width.getQuantity() > 16) {
6150     const Type *Base = nullptr;
6151     uint64_t Members = 0;
6152     IsIndirect = !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members);
6153   }
6154 
6155   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect,
6156                           TyInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
6157 }
6158 
6159 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6160                                     QualType Ty) const {
6161   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
6162                           CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
6163                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
6164                           /*allowHigherAlign*/ false);
6165 }
6166 
6167 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6168 // ARM ABI Implementation
6169 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6170 
6171 namespace {
6172 
6173 class ARMABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
6174 public:
6175   enum ABIKind {
6176     APCS = 0,
6177     AAPCS = 1,
6178     AAPCS_VFP = 2,
6179     AAPCS16_VFP = 3,
6180   };
6181 
6182 private:
6183   ABIKind Kind;
6184   bool IsFloatABISoftFP;
6185 
6186 public:
6187   ARMABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind _Kind)
6188       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(_Kind) {
6189     setCCs();
6190     IsFloatABISoftFP = CGT.getCodeGenOpts().FloatABI == "softfp" ||
6191         CGT.getCodeGenOpts().FloatABI == ""; // default
6192   }
6193 
6194   bool isEABI() const {
6195     switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) {
6196     case llvm::Triple::Android:
6197     case llvm::Triple::EABI:
6198     case llvm::Triple::EABIHF:
6199     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABI:
6200     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF:
6201     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABI:
6202     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF:
6203       return true;
6204     default:
6205       return false;
6206     }
6207   }
6208 
6209   bool isEABIHF() const {
6210     switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) {
6211     case llvm::Triple::EABIHF:
6212     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF:
6213     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF:
6214       return true;
6215     default:
6216       return false;
6217     }
6218   }
6219 
6220   ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; }
6221 
6222   bool allowBFloatArgsAndRet() const override {
6223     return !IsFloatABISoftFP && getTarget().hasBFloat16Type();
6224   }
6225 
6226 private:
6227   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic,
6228                                 unsigned functionCallConv) const;
6229   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic,
6230                                   unsigned functionCallConv) const;
6231   ABIArgInfo classifyHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *Base,
6232                                           uint64_t Members) const;
6233   ABIArgInfo coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const;
6234   bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
6235   bool containsAnyFP16Vectors(QualType Ty) const;
6236 
6237   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
6238   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
6239                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
6240 
6241   bool isEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP(unsigned callConvention, bool acceptHalf) const;
6242 
6243   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
6244 
6245   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6246                     QualType Ty) const override;
6247 
6248   llvm::CallingConv::ID getLLVMDefaultCC() const;
6249   llvm::CallingConv::ID getABIDefaultCC() const;
6250   void setCCs();
6251 
6252   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
6253                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
6254     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
6255   }
6256   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
6257     return true;
6258   }
6259   bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy,
6260                                  unsigned elts) const override;
6261 };
6262 
6263 class ARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6264 public:
6265   ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K)
6266       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<ARMABIInfo>(CGT, K)) {}
6267 
6268   const ARMABIInfo &getABIInfo() const {
6269     return static_cast<const ARMABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo());
6270   }
6271 
6272   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
6273     return 13;
6274   }
6275 
6276   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
6277     return "mov\tr7, r7\t\t// marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
6278   }
6279 
6280   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
6281                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
6282     llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
6283 
6284     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
6285     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 15);
6286     return false;
6287   }
6288 
6289   unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override {
6290     if (getABIInfo().isEABI()) return 88;
6291     return TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException();
6292   }
6293 
6294   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6295                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
6296     if (GV->isDeclaration())
6297       return;
6298     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
6299     if (!FD)
6300       return;
6301 
6302     const ARMInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>();
6303     if (!Attr)
6304       return;
6305 
6306     const char *Kind;
6307     switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) {
6308     case ARMInterruptAttr::Generic: Kind = ""; break;
6309     case ARMInterruptAttr::IRQ:     Kind = "IRQ"; break;
6310     case ARMInterruptAttr::FIQ:     Kind = "FIQ"; break;
6311     case ARMInterruptAttr::SWI:     Kind = "SWI"; break;
6312     case ARMInterruptAttr::ABORT:   Kind = "ABORT"; break;
6313     case ARMInterruptAttr::UNDEF:   Kind = "UNDEF"; break;
6314     }
6315 
6316     llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
6317 
6318     Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind);
6319 
6320     ARMABIInfo::ABIKind ABI = cast<ARMABIInfo>(getABIInfo()).getABIKind();
6321     if (ABI == ARMABIInfo::APCS)
6322       return;
6323 
6324     // AAPCS guarantees that sp will be 8-byte aligned on any public interface,
6325     // however this is not necessarily true on taking any interrupt. Instruct
6326     // the backend to perform a realignment as part of the function prologue.
6327     llvm::AttrBuilder B;
6328     B.addStackAlignmentAttr(8);
6329     Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
6330   }
6331 };
6332 
6333 class WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public ARMTargetCodeGenInfo {
6334 public:
6335   WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K)
6336       : ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {}
6337 
6338   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6339                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
6340 
6341   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
6342                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
6343     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
6344   }
6345 
6346   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value,
6347                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
6348     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
6349   }
6350 };
6351 
6352 void WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
6353     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
6354   ARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
6355   if (GV->isDeclaration())
6356     return;
6357   addStackProbeTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
6358 }
6359 }
6360 
6361 void ARMABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
6362   if (!::classifyReturnType(getCXXABI(), FI, *this))
6363     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic(),
6364                                             FI.getCallingConvention());
6365 
6366   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
6367     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, FI.isVariadic(),
6368                                   FI.getCallingConvention());
6369 
6370 
6371   // Always honor user-specified calling convention.
6372   if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C)
6373     return;
6374 
6375   llvm::CallingConv::ID cc = getRuntimeCC();
6376   if (cc != llvm::CallingConv::C)
6377     FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(cc);
6378 }
6379 
6380 /// Return the default calling convention that LLVM will use.
6381 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getLLVMDefaultCC() const {
6382   // The default calling convention that LLVM will infer.
6383   if (isEABIHF() || getTarget().getTriple().isWatchABI())
6384     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
6385   else if (isEABI())
6386     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS;
6387   else
6388     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS;
6389 }
6390 
6391 /// Return the calling convention that our ABI would like us to use
6392 /// as the C calling convention.
6393 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getABIDefaultCC() const {
6394   switch (getABIKind()) {
6395   case APCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS;
6396   case AAPCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS;
6397   case AAPCS_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
6398   case AAPCS16_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
6399   }
6400   llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind");
6401 }
6402 
6403 void ARMABIInfo::setCCs() {
6404   assert(getRuntimeCC() == llvm::CallingConv::C);
6405 
6406   // Don't muddy up the IR with a ton of explicit annotations if
6407   // they'd just match what LLVM will infer from the triple.
6408   llvm::CallingConv::ID abiCC = getABIDefaultCC();
6409   if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC())
6410     RuntimeCC = abiCC;
6411 }
6412 
6413 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::coerceIllegalVector(QualType Ty) const {
6414   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
6415   if (Size <= 32) {
6416     llvm::Type *ResType =
6417         llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
6418     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
6419   }
6420   if (Size == 64 || Size == 128) {
6421     auto *ResType = llvm::FixedVectorType::get(
6422         llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), Size / 32);
6423     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
6424   }
6425   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
6426 }
6427 
6428 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty,
6429                                                     const Type *Base,
6430                                                     uint64_t Members) const {
6431   assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate");
6432   // Base can be a floating-point or a vector.
6433   if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) {
6434     // FP16 vectors should be converted to integer vectors
6435     if (!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() && containsAnyFP16Vectors(Ty)) {
6436       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
6437       auto *NewVecTy = llvm::FixedVectorType::get(
6438           llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), Size / 32);
6439       llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(NewVecTy, Members);
6440       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false);
6441     }
6442   }
6443   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false);
6444 }
6445 
6446 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, bool isVariadic,
6447                                             unsigned functionCallConv) const {
6448   // 6.1.2.1 The following argument types are VFP CPRCs:
6449   //   A single-precision floating-point type (including promoted
6450   //   half-precision types); A double-precision floating-point type;
6451   //   A 64-bit or 128-bit containerized vector type; Homogeneous Aggregate
6452   //   with a Base Type of a single- or double-precision floating-point type,
6453   //   64-bit containerized vectors or 128-bit containerized vectors with one
6454   //   to four Elements.
6455   // Variadic functions should always marshal to the base standard.
6456   bool IsAAPCS_VFP =
6457       !isVariadic && isEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP(functionCallConv, /* AAPCS16 */ false);
6458 
6459   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
6460 
6461   // Handle illegal vector types here.
6462   if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty))
6463     return coerceIllegalVector(Ty);
6464 
6465   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
6466     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6467     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
6468       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6469     }
6470 
6471     if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
6472       if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
6473         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
6474 
6475     return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
6476                                               : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6477   }
6478 
6479   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
6480     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
6481   }
6482 
6483   // Ignore empty records.
6484   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
6485     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6486 
6487   if (IsAAPCS_VFP) {
6488     // Homogeneous Aggregates need to be expanded when we can fit the aggregate
6489     // into VFP registers.
6490     const Type *Base = nullptr;
6491     uint64_t Members = 0;
6492     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members))
6493       return classifyHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members);
6494   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) {
6495     // WatchOS does have homogeneous aggregates. Note that we intentionally use
6496     // this convention even for a variadic function: the backend will use GPRs
6497     // if needed.
6498     const Type *Base = nullptr;
6499     uint64_t Members = 0;
6500     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
6501       assert(Base && Members <= 4 && "unexpected homogeneous aggregate");
6502       llvm::Type *Ty =
6503         llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members);
6504       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false);
6505     }
6506   }
6507 
6508   if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP &&
6509       getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)) {
6510     // WatchOS is adopting the 64-bit AAPCS rule on composite types: if they're
6511     // bigger than 128-bits, they get placed in space allocated by the caller,
6512     // and a pointer is passed.
6513     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(
6514         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8), false);
6515   }
6516 
6517   // Support byval for ARM.
6518   // The ABI alignment for APCS is 4-byte and for AAPCS at least 4-byte and at
6519   // most 8-byte. We realign the indirect argument if type alignment is bigger
6520   // than ABI alignment.
6521   uint64_t ABIAlign = 4;
6522   uint64_t TyAlign;
6523   if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP ||
6524       getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) {
6525     TyAlign = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity();
6526     ABIAlign = std::min(std::max(TyAlign, (uint64_t)4), (uint64_t)8);
6527   } else {
6528     TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity();
6529   }
6530   if (getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(64)) {
6531     assert(getABIKind() != ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && "unexpected byval");
6532     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign),
6533                                    /*ByVal=*/true,
6534                                    /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign);
6535   }
6536 
6537   // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 64 bytes to an integer array of
6538   // same size and alignment.
6539   if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
6540     return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext());
6541   }
6542 
6543   // Otherwise, pass by coercing to a structure of the appropriate size.
6544   llvm::Type* ElemTy;
6545   unsigned SizeRegs;
6546   // FIXME: Try to match the types of the arguments more accurately where
6547   // we can.
6548   if (TyAlign <= 4) {
6549     ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
6550     SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
6551   } else {
6552     ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext());
6553     SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 63) / 64;
6554   }
6555 
6556   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(ElemTy, SizeRegs));
6557 }
6558 
6559 static bool isIntegerLikeType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context,
6560                               llvm::LLVMContext &VMContext) {
6561   // APCS, C Language Calling Conventions, Non-Simple Return Values: A structure
6562   // is called integer-like if its size is less than or equal to one word, and
6563   // the offset of each of its addressable sub-fields is zero.
6564 
6565   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
6566 
6567   // Check that the type fits in a word.
6568   if (Size > 32)
6569     return false;
6570 
6571   // FIXME: Handle vector types!
6572   if (Ty->isVectorType())
6573     return false;
6574 
6575   // Float types are never treated as "integer like".
6576   if (Ty->isRealFloatingType())
6577     return false;
6578 
6579   // If this is a builtin or pointer type then it is ok.
6580   if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->isPointerType())
6581     return true;
6582 
6583   // Small complex integer types are "integer like".
6584   if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
6585     return isIntegerLikeType(CT->getElementType(), Context, VMContext);
6586 
6587   // Single element and zero sized arrays should be allowed, by the definition
6588   // above, but they are not.
6589 
6590   // Otherwise, it must be a record type.
6591   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6592   if (!RT) return false;
6593 
6594   // Ignore records with flexible arrays.
6595   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6596   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
6597     return false;
6598 
6599   // Check that all sub-fields are at offset 0, and are themselves "integer
6600   // like".
6601   const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6602 
6603   bool HadField = false;
6604   unsigned idx = 0;
6605   for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
6606        i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
6607     const FieldDecl *FD = *i;
6608 
6609     // Bit-fields are not addressable, we only need to verify they are "integer
6610     // like". We still have to disallow a subsequent non-bitfield, for example:
6611     //   struct { int : 0; int x }
6612     // is non-integer like according to gcc.
6613     if (FD->isBitField()) {
6614       if (!RD->isUnion())
6615         HadField = true;
6616 
6617       if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext))
6618         return false;
6619 
6620       continue;
6621     }
6622 
6623     // Check if this field is at offset 0.
6624     if (Layout.getFieldOffset(idx) != 0)
6625       return false;
6626 
6627     if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext))
6628       return false;
6629 
6630     // Only allow at most one field in a structure. This doesn't match the
6631     // wording above, but follows gcc in situations with a field following an
6632     // empty structure.
6633     if (!RD->isUnion()) {
6634       if (HadField)
6635         return false;
6636 
6637       HadField = true;
6638     }
6639   }
6640 
6641   return true;
6642 }
6643 
6644 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic,
6645                                           unsigned functionCallConv) const {
6646 
6647   // Variadic functions should always marshal to the base standard.
6648   bool IsAAPCS_VFP =
6649       !isVariadic && isEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP(functionCallConv, /* AAPCS16 */ true);
6650 
6651   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
6652     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6653 
6654   if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
6655     // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
6656     if (getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128)
6657       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
6658     // TODO: FP16/BF16 vectors should be converted to integer vectors
6659     // This check is similar  to isIllegalVectorType - refactor?
6660     if ((!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() &&
6661         (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() ||
6662          VT->getElementType()->isHalfType())) ||
6663         (IsFloatABISoftFP &&
6664          VT->getElementType()->isBFloat16Type()))
6665       return coerceIllegalVector(RetTy);
6666   }
6667 
6668   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
6669     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6670     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
6671       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6672 
6673     if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
6674       if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
6675         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false);
6676 
6677     return isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
6678                                                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
6679   }
6680 
6681   // Are we following APCS?
6682   if (getABIKind() == APCS) {
6683     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, false))
6684       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6685 
6686     // Complex types are all returned as packed integers.
6687     //
6688     // FIXME: Consider using 2 x vector types if the back end handles them
6689     // correctly.
6690     if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
6691       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(
6692           getVMContext(), getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy)));
6693 
6694     // Integer like structures are returned in r0.
6695     if (isIntegerLikeType(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext())) {
6696       // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
6697       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
6698       if (Size <= 8)
6699         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
6700       if (Size <= 16)
6701         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
6702       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
6703     }
6704 
6705     // Otherwise return in memory.
6706     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
6707   }
6708 
6709   // Otherwise this is an AAPCS variant.
6710 
6711   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
6712     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6713 
6714   // Check for homogeneous aggregates with AAPCS-VFP.
6715   if (IsAAPCS_VFP) {
6716     const Type *Base = nullptr;
6717     uint64_t Members = 0;
6718     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members))
6719       return classifyHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members);
6720   }
6721 
6722   // Aggregates <= 4 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates
6723   // are returned indirectly.
6724   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
6725   if (Size <= 32) {
6726     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 4 bytes to an integer array of
6727     // same size and alignment.
6728     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
6729       return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext());
6730     }
6731     if (getDataLayout().isBigEndian())
6732       // Return in 32 bit integer integer type (as if loaded by LDR, AAPCS 5.4)
6733       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
6734 
6735     // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
6736     if (Size <= 8)
6737       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
6738     if (Size <= 16)
6739       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
6740     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
6741   } else if (Size <= 128 && getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) {
6742     llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
6743     llvm::Type *CoerceTy =
6744         llvm::ArrayType::get(Int32Ty, llvm::alignTo(Size, 32) / 32);
6745     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
6746   }
6747 
6748   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
6749 }
6750 
6751 /// isIllegalVector - check whether Ty is an illegal vector type.
6752 bool ARMABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
6753   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType> ()) {
6754     // On targets that don't support half, fp16 or bfloat, they are expanded
6755     // into float, and we don't want the ABI to depend on whether or not they
6756     // are supported in hardware. Thus return false to coerce vectors of these
6757     // types into integer vectors.
6758     // We do not depend on hasLegalHalfType for bfloat as it is a
6759     // separate IR type.
6760     if ((!getTarget().hasLegalHalfType() &&
6761         (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() ||
6762          VT->getElementType()->isHalfType())) ||
6763         (IsFloatABISoftFP &&
6764          VT->getElementType()->isBFloat16Type()))
6765       return true;
6766     if (isAndroid()) {
6767       // Android shipped using Clang 3.1, which supported a slightly different
6768       // vector ABI. The primary differences were that 3-element vector types
6769       // were legal, and so were sub 32-bit vectors (i.e. <2 x i8>). This path
6770       // accepts that legacy behavior for Android only.
6771       // Check whether VT is legal.
6772       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
6773       // NumElements should be power of 2 or equal to 3.
6774       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements) && NumElements != 3)
6775         return true;
6776     } else {
6777       // Check whether VT is legal.
6778       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
6779       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
6780       // NumElements should be power of 2.
6781       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements))
6782         return true;
6783       // Size should be greater than 32 bits.
6784       return Size <= 32;
6785     }
6786   }
6787   return false;
6788 }
6789 
6790 /// Return true if a type contains any 16-bit floating point vectors
6791 bool ARMABIInfo::containsAnyFP16Vectors(QualType Ty) const {
6792   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
6793     uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
6794     if (NElements == 0)
6795       return false;
6796     return containsAnyFP16Vectors(AT->getElementType());
6797   } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
6798     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6799 
6800     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
6801     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
6802       if (llvm::any_of(CXXRD->bases(), [this](const CXXBaseSpecifier &B) {
6803             return containsAnyFP16Vectors(B.getType());
6804           }))
6805         return true;
6806 
6807     if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(), [this](FieldDecl *FD) {
6808           return FD && containsAnyFP16Vectors(FD->getType());
6809         }))
6810       return true;
6811 
6812     return false;
6813   } else {
6814     if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>())
6815       return (VT->getElementType()->isFloat16Type() ||
6816               VT->getElementType()->isBFloat16Type() ||
6817               VT->getElementType()->isHalfType());
6818     return false;
6819   }
6820 }
6821 
6822 bool ARMABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize,
6823                                            llvm::Type *eltTy,
6824                                            unsigned numElts) const {
6825   if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(numElts))
6826     return false;
6827   unsigned size = getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSizeInBits(eltTy);
6828   if (size > 64)
6829     return false;
6830   if (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 8 &&
6831       (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 16 || numElts == 1))
6832     return false;
6833   return true;
6834 }
6835 
6836 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
6837   // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS-VFP must have base types of float,
6838   // double, or 64-bit or 128-bit vectors.
6839   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
6840     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
6841         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double ||
6842         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)
6843       return true;
6844   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
6845     unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
6846     if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128)
6847       return true;
6848   }
6849   return false;
6850 }
6851 
6852 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
6853                                                    uint64_t Members) const {
6854   return Members <= 4;
6855 }
6856 
6857 bool ARMABIInfo::isEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP(unsigned callConvention,
6858                                         bool acceptHalf) const {
6859   // Give precedence to user-specified calling conventions.
6860   if (callConvention != llvm::CallingConv::C)
6861     return (callConvention == llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP);
6862   else
6863     return (getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP) ||
6864            (acceptHalf && (getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP));
6865 }
6866 
6867 Address ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6868                               QualType Ty) const {
6869   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
6870 
6871   // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes.
6872   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) {
6873     Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize);
6874     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
6875     return Addr;
6876   }
6877 
6878   CharUnits TySize = getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty);
6879   CharUnits TyAlignForABI = getContext().getTypeUnadjustedAlignInChars(Ty);
6880 
6881   // Use indirect if size of the illegal vector is bigger than 16 bytes.
6882   bool IsIndirect = false;
6883   const Type *Base = nullptr;
6884   uint64_t Members = 0;
6885   if (TySize > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) {
6886     IsIndirect = true;
6887 
6888   // ARMv7k passes structs bigger than 16 bytes indirectly, in space
6889   // allocated by the caller.
6890   } else if (TySize > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) &&
6891              getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP &&
6892              !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
6893     IsIndirect = true;
6894 
6895   // Otherwise, bound the type's ABI alignment.
6896   // The ABI alignment for 64-bit or 128-bit vectors is 8 for AAPCS and 4 for
6897   // APCS. For AAPCS, the ABI alignment is at least 4-byte and at most 8-byte.
6898   // Our callers should be prepared to handle an under-aligned address.
6899   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP ||
6900              getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) {
6901     TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4));
6902     TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
6903   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) {
6904     // ARMv7k allows type alignment up to 16 bytes.
6905     TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4));
6906     TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
6907   } else {
6908     TyAlignForABI = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
6909   }
6910 
6911   TypeInfoChars TyInfo(TySize, TyAlignForABI, false);
6912   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TyInfo,
6913                           SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
6914 }
6915 
6916 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6917 // NVPTX ABI Implementation
6918 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6919 
6920 namespace {
6921 
6922 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo;
6923 
6924 class NVPTXABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
6925   NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo &CGInfo;
6926 
6927 public:
6928   NVPTXABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo &Info)
6929       : ABIInfo(CGT), CGInfo(Info) {}
6930 
6931   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
6932   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
6933 
6934   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
6935   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6936                     QualType Ty) const override;
6937   bool isUnsupportedType(QualType T) const;
6938   ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArrayWithLimit(QualType Ty, unsigned MaxSize) const;
6939 };
6940 
6941 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6942 public:
6943   NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
6944       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<NVPTXABIInfo>(CGT, *this)) {}
6945 
6946   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6947                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
6948   bool shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const override;
6949 
6950   llvm::Type *getCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceDeviceType() const override {
6951     // On the device side, surface reference is represented as an object handle
6952     // in 64-bit integer.
6953     return llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getABIInfo().getVMContext());
6954   }
6955 
6956   llvm::Type *getCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureDeviceType() const override {
6957     // On the device side, texture reference is represented as an object handle
6958     // in 64-bit integer.
6959     return llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getABIInfo().getVMContext());
6960   }
6961 
6962   bool emitCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceDeviceCopy(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue Dst,
6963                                               LValue Src) const override {
6964     emitBuiltinSurfTexDeviceCopy(CGF, Dst, Src);
6965     return true;
6966   }
6967 
6968   bool emitCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureDeviceCopy(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue Dst,
6969                                               LValue Src) const override {
6970     emitBuiltinSurfTexDeviceCopy(CGF, Dst, Src);
6971     return true;
6972   }
6973 
6974 private:
6975   // Adds a NamedMDNode with GV, Name, and Operand as operands, and adds the
6976   // resulting MDNode to the nvvm.annotations MDNode.
6977   static void addNVVMMetadata(llvm::GlobalValue *GV, StringRef Name,
6978                               int Operand);
6979 
6980   static void emitBuiltinSurfTexDeviceCopy(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue Dst,
6981                                            LValue Src) {
6982     llvm::Value *Handle = nullptr;
6983     llvm::Constant *C =
6984         llvm::dyn_cast<llvm::Constant>(Src.getAddress(CGF).getPointer());
6985     // Lookup `addrspacecast` through the constant pointer if any.
6986     if (auto *ASC = llvm::dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::AddrSpaceCastOperator>(C))
6987       C = llvm::cast<llvm::Constant>(ASC->getPointerOperand());
6988     if (auto *GV = llvm::dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::GlobalVariable>(C)) {
6989       // Load the handle from the specific global variable using
6990       // `nvvm.texsurf.handle.internal` intrinsic.
6991       Handle = CGF.EmitRuntimeCall(
6992           CGF.CGM.getIntrinsic(llvm::Intrinsic::nvvm_texsurf_handle_internal,
6993                                {GV->getType()}),
6994           {GV}, "texsurf_handle");
6995     } else
6996       Handle = CGF.EmitLoadOfScalar(Src, SourceLocation());
6997     CGF.EmitStoreOfScalar(Handle, Dst);
6998   }
6999 };
7000 
7001 /// Checks if the type is unsupported directly by the current target.
7002 bool NVPTXABIInfo::isUnsupportedType(QualType T) const {
7003   ASTContext &Context = getContext();
7004   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat16Type() && T->isFloat16Type())
7005     return true;
7006   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type() &&
7007       (T->isFloat128Type() ||
7008        (T->isRealFloatingType() && Context.getTypeSize(T) == 128)))
7009     return true;
7010   if (const auto *EIT = T->getAs<ExtIntType>())
7011     return EIT->getNumBits() >
7012            (Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() ? 128U : 64U);
7013   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() && T->isIntegerType() &&
7014       Context.getTypeSize(T) > 64U)
7015     return true;
7016   if (const auto *AT = T->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
7017     return isUnsupportedType(AT->getElementType());
7018   const auto *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
7019   if (!RT)
7020     return false;
7021   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
7022 
7023   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
7024   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
7025     for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &I : CXXRD->bases())
7026       if (isUnsupportedType(I.getType()))
7027         return true;
7028 
7029   for (const FieldDecl *I : RD->fields())
7030     if (isUnsupportedType(I->getType()))
7031       return true;
7032   return false;
7033 }
7034 
7035 /// Coerce the given type into an array with maximum allowed size of elements.
7036 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::coerceToIntArrayWithLimit(QualType Ty,
7037                                                    unsigned MaxSize) const {
7038   // Alignment and Size are measured in bits.
7039   const uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7040   const uint64_t Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty);
7041   const unsigned Div = std::min<unsigned>(MaxSize, Alignment);
7042   llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(getVMContext(), Div);
7043   const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Div - 1) / Div;
7044   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements));
7045 }
7046 
7047 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
7048   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
7049     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7050 
7051   if (getContext().getLangOpts().OpenMP &&
7052       getContext().getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && isUnsupportedType(RetTy))
7053     return coerceToIntArrayWithLimit(RetTy, 64);
7054 
7055   // note: this is different from default ABI
7056   if (!RetTy->isScalarType())
7057     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7058 
7059   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7060   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
7061     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7062 
7063   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
7064                                                : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
7065 }
7066 
7067 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7068   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7069   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7070     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7071 
7072   // Return aggregates type as indirect by value
7073   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
7074     // Under CUDA device compilation, tex/surf builtin types are replaced with
7075     // object types and passed directly.
7076     if (getContext().getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) {
7077       if (Ty->isCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceType())
7078         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
7079             CGInfo.getCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceDeviceType());
7080       if (Ty->isCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureType())
7081         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
7082             CGInfo.getCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureDeviceType());
7083     }
7084     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true);
7085   }
7086 
7087   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
7088     if ((EIT->getNumBits() > 128) ||
7089         (!getContext().getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() &&
7090          EIT->getNumBits() > 64))
7091       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true);
7092   }
7093 
7094   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
7095                                             : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
7096 }
7097 
7098 void NVPTXABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7099   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7100     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7101   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7102     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
7103 
7104   // Always honor user-specified calling convention.
7105   if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C)
7106     return;
7107 
7108   FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(getRuntimeCC());
7109 }
7110 
7111 Address NVPTXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7112                                 QualType Ty) const {
7113   llvm_unreachable("NVPTX does not support varargs");
7114 }
7115 
7116 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
7117     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
7118   if (GV->isDeclaration())
7119     return;
7120   const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(D);
7121   if (VD) {
7122     if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) {
7123       if (VD->getType()->isCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceType())
7124         addNVVMMetadata(GV, "surface", 1);
7125       else if (VD->getType()->isCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureType())
7126         addNVVMMetadata(GV, "texture", 1);
7127       return;
7128     }
7129   }
7130 
7131   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
7132   if (!FD) return;
7133 
7134   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
7135 
7136   // Perform special handling in OpenCL mode
7137   if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
7138     // Use OpenCL function attributes to check for kernel functions
7139     // By default, all functions are device functions
7140     if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
7141       // OpenCL __kernel functions get kernel metadata
7142       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node
7143       addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1);
7144       // And kernel functions are not subject to inlining
7145       F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
7146     }
7147   }
7148 
7149   // Perform special handling in CUDA mode.
7150   if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) {
7151     // CUDA __global__ functions get a kernel metadata entry.  Since
7152     // __global__ functions cannot be called from the device, we do not
7153     // need to set the noinline attribute.
7154     if (FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
7155       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node
7156       addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1);
7157     }
7158     if (CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<CUDALaunchBoundsAttr>()) {
7159       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"maxntidx", i32 <val>} node
7160       llvm::APSInt MaxThreads(32);
7161       MaxThreads = Attr->getMaxThreads()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext());
7162       if (MaxThreads > 0)
7163         addNVVMMetadata(F, "maxntidx", MaxThreads.getExtValue());
7164 
7165       // min blocks is an optional argument for CUDALaunchBoundsAttr. If it was
7166       // not specified in __launch_bounds__ or if the user specified a 0 value,
7167       // we don't have to add a PTX directive.
7168       if (Attr->getMinBlocks()) {
7169         llvm::APSInt MinBlocks(32);
7170         MinBlocks = Attr->getMinBlocks()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext());
7171         if (MinBlocks > 0)
7172           // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"minctasm", i32 <val>} node
7173           addNVVMMetadata(F, "minctasm", MinBlocks.getExtValue());
7174       }
7175     }
7176   }
7177 }
7178 
7179 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::addNVVMMetadata(llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7180                                              StringRef Name, int Operand) {
7181   llvm::Module *M = GV->getParent();
7182   llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = M->getContext();
7183 
7184   // Get "nvvm.annotations" metadata node
7185   llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = M->getOrInsertNamedMetadata("nvvm.annotations");
7186 
7187   llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {
7188       llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV), llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Name),
7189       llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(
7190           llvm::ConstantInt::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx), Operand))};
7191   // Append metadata to nvvm.annotations
7192   MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals));
7193 }
7194 
7195 bool NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const {
7196   return false;
7197 }
7198 }
7199 
7200 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7201 // SystemZ ABI Implementation
7202 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7203 
7204 namespace {
7205 
7206 class SystemZABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
7207   bool HasVector;
7208   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
7209 
7210 public:
7211   SystemZABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HV, bool SF)
7212     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), HasVector(HV), IsSoftFloatABI(SF) {}
7213 
7214   bool isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const;
7215   bool isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const;
7216   bool isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
7217   bool isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
7218   QualType GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const;
7219 
7220   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
7221   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType ArgTy) const;
7222 
7223   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
7224     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7225       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7226     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7227       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
7228   }
7229 
7230   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7231                     QualType Ty) const override;
7232 
7233   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
7234                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
7235     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
7236   }
7237   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
7238     return false;
7239   }
7240 };
7241 
7242 class SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7243 public:
7244   SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HasVector, bool SoftFloatABI)
7245       : TargetCodeGenInfo(
7246             std::make_unique<SystemZABIInfo>(CGT, HasVector, SoftFloatABI)) {}
7247 };
7248 
7249 }
7250 
7251 bool SystemZABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const {
7252   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7253   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7254     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7255 
7256   // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI.
7257   if (ABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty))
7258     return true;
7259 
7260   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
7261     if (EIT->getNumBits() < 64)
7262       return true;
7263 
7264   // 32-bit values must also be promoted.
7265   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
7266     switch (BT->getKind()) {
7267     case BuiltinType::Int:
7268     case BuiltinType::UInt:
7269       return true;
7270     default:
7271       return false;
7272     }
7273   return false;
7274 }
7275 
7276 bool SystemZABIInfo::isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const {
7277   return (Ty->isAnyComplexType() ||
7278           Ty->isVectorType() ||
7279           isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty));
7280 }
7281 
7282 bool SystemZABIInfo::isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7283   return (HasVector &&
7284           Ty->isVectorType() &&
7285           getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128);
7286 }
7287 
7288 bool SystemZABIInfo::isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7289   if (IsSoftFloatABI)
7290     return false;
7291 
7292   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
7293     switch (BT->getKind()) {
7294     case BuiltinType::Float:
7295     case BuiltinType::Double:
7296       return true;
7297     default:
7298       return false;
7299     }
7300 
7301   return false;
7302 }
7303 
7304 QualType SystemZABIInfo::GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const {
7305   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
7306 
7307   if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) {
7308     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
7309     QualType Found;
7310 
7311     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
7312     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
7313       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
7314         QualType Base = I.getType();
7315 
7316         // Empty bases don't affect things either way.
7317         if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base, true))
7318           continue;
7319 
7320         if (!Found.isNull())
7321           return Ty;
7322         Found = GetSingleElementType(Base);
7323       }
7324 
7325     // Check the fields.
7326     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
7327       // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode.
7328       // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), empty structure and array fields
7329       // do count.  So do anonymous bitfields that aren't zero-sized.
7330       if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
7331           FD->isZeroLengthBitField(getContext()))
7332         continue;
7333       // Like isSingleElementStruct(), ignore C++20 empty data members.
7334       if (FD->hasAttr<NoUniqueAddressAttr>() &&
7335           isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FD->getType(), true))
7336         continue;
7337 
7338       // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), arrays do not count.
7339       // Nested structures still do though.
7340       if (!Found.isNull())
7341         return Ty;
7342       Found = GetSingleElementType(FD->getType());
7343     }
7344 
7345     // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), trailing padding is allowed.
7346     // An 8-byte aligned struct s { float f; } is passed as a double.
7347     if (!Found.isNull())
7348       return Found;
7349   }
7350 
7351   return Ty;
7352 }
7353 
7354 Address SystemZABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7355                                   QualType Ty) const {
7356   // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type:
7357   // struct {
7358   //   i64 __gpr;
7359   //   i64 __fpr;
7360   //   i8 *__overflow_arg_area;
7361   //   i8 *__reg_save_area;
7362   // };
7363 
7364   // Every non-vector argument occupies 8 bytes and is passed by preference
7365   // in either GPRs or FPRs.  Vector arguments occupy 8 or 16 bytes and are
7366   // always passed on the stack.
7367   Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty);
7368   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
7369   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
7370   llvm::Type *DirectTy = ArgTy;
7371   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
7372   bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect();
7373   bool InFPRs = false;
7374   bool IsVector = false;
7375   CharUnits UnpaddedSize;
7376   CharUnits DirectAlign;
7377   if (IsIndirect) {
7378     DirectTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(DirectTy);
7379     UnpaddedSize = DirectAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
7380   } else {
7381     if (AI.getCoerceToType())
7382       ArgTy = AI.getCoerceToType();
7383     InFPRs = (!IsSoftFloatABI && (ArgTy->isFloatTy() || ArgTy->isDoubleTy()));
7384     IsVector = ArgTy->isVectorTy();
7385     UnpaddedSize = TyInfo.Width;
7386     DirectAlign = TyInfo.Align;
7387   }
7388   CharUnits PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
7389   if (IsVector && UnpaddedSize > PaddedSize)
7390     PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
7391   assert((UnpaddedSize <= PaddedSize) && "Invalid argument size.");
7392 
7393   CharUnits Padding = (PaddedSize - UnpaddedSize);
7394 
7395   llvm::Type *IndexTy = CGF.Int64Ty;
7396   llvm::Value *PaddedSizeV =
7397     llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, PaddedSize.getQuantity());
7398 
7399   if (IsVector) {
7400     // Work out the address of a vector argument on the stack.
7401     // Vector arguments are always passed in the high bits of a
7402     // single (8 byte) or double (16 byte) stack slot.
7403     Address OverflowArgAreaPtr =
7404         CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_ptr");
7405     Address OverflowArgArea =
7406       Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"),
7407               TyInfo.Align);
7408     Address MemAddr =
7409       CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArgArea, DirectTy, "mem_addr");
7410 
7411     // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer
7412     llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea =
7413       CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV,
7414                             "overflow_arg_area");
7415     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr);
7416 
7417     return MemAddr;
7418   }
7419 
7420   assert(PaddedSize.getQuantity() == 8);
7421 
7422   unsigned MaxRegs, RegCountField, RegSaveIndex;
7423   CharUnits RegPadding;
7424   if (InFPRs) {
7425     MaxRegs = 4; // Maximum of 4 FPR arguments
7426     RegCountField = 1; // __fpr
7427     RegSaveIndex = 16; // save offset for f0
7428     RegPadding = CharUnits(); // floats are passed in the high bits of an FPR
7429   } else {
7430     MaxRegs = 5; // Maximum of 5 GPR arguments
7431     RegCountField = 0; // __gpr
7432     RegSaveIndex = 2; // save offset for r2
7433     RegPadding = Padding; // values are passed in the low bits of a GPR
7434   }
7435 
7436   Address RegCountPtr =
7437       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, RegCountField, "reg_count_ptr");
7438   llvm::Value *RegCount = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegCountPtr, "reg_count");
7439   llvm::Value *MaxRegsV = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, MaxRegs);
7440   llvm::Value *InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULT(RegCount, MaxRegsV,
7441                                                  "fits_in_regs");
7442 
7443   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
7444   llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem");
7445   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
7446   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock);
7447 
7448   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers.
7449   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
7450 
7451   // Work out the address of an argument register.
7452   llvm::Value *ScaledRegCount =
7453     CGF.Builder.CreateMul(RegCount, PaddedSizeV, "scaled_reg_count");
7454   llvm::Value *RegBase =
7455     llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, RegSaveIndex * PaddedSize.getQuantity()
7456                                       + RegPadding.getQuantity());
7457   llvm::Value *RegOffset =
7458     CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(ScaledRegCount, RegBase, "reg_offset");
7459   Address RegSaveAreaPtr =
7460       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, "reg_save_area_ptr");
7461   llvm::Value *RegSaveArea =
7462     CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr, "reg_save_area");
7463   Address RawRegAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, RegOffset,
7464                                            "raw_reg_addr"),
7465                      PaddedSize);
7466   Address RegAddr =
7467     CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawRegAddr, DirectTy, "reg_addr");
7468 
7469   // Update the register count
7470   llvm::Value *One = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, 1);
7471   llvm::Value *NewRegCount =
7472     CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(RegCount, One, "reg_count");
7473   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewRegCount, RegCountPtr);
7474   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
7475 
7476   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory.
7477   CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock);
7478 
7479   // Work out the address of a stack argument.
7480   Address OverflowArgAreaPtr =
7481       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "overflow_arg_area_ptr");
7482   Address OverflowArgArea =
7483     Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"),
7484             PaddedSize);
7485   Address RawMemAddr =
7486     CGF.Builder.CreateConstByteGEP(OverflowArgArea, Padding, "raw_mem_addr");
7487   Address MemAddr =
7488     CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawMemAddr, DirectTy, "mem_addr");
7489 
7490   // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer
7491   llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea =
7492     CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV,
7493                           "overflow_arg_area");
7494   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr);
7495   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
7496 
7497   // Return the appropriate result.
7498   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
7499   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock,
7500                                  MemAddr, InMemBlock, "va_arg.addr");
7501 
7502   if (IsIndirect)
7503     ResAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "indirect_arg"),
7504                       TyInfo.Align);
7505 
7506   return ResAddr;
7507 }
7508 
7509 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
7510   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
7511     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7512   if (isVectorArgumentType(RetTy))
7513     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7514   if (isCompoundType(RetTy) || getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64)
7515     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
7516   return (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
7517                                                : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
7518 }
7519 
7520 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7521   // Handle the generic C++ ABI.
7522   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
7523     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
7524 
7525   // Integers and enums are extended to full register width.
7526   if (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty))
7527     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
7528 
7529   // Handle vector types and vector-like structure types.  Note that
7530   // as opposed to float-like structure types, we do not allow any
7531   // padding for vector-like structures, so verify the sizes match.
7532   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7533   QualType SingleElementTy = GetSingleElementType(Ty);
7534   if (isVectorArgumentType(SingleElementTy) &&
7535       getContext().getTypeSize(SingleElementTy) == Size)
7536     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(SingleElementTy));
7537 
7538   // Values that are not 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes in size are passed indirectly.
7539   if (Size != 8 && Size != 16 && Size != 32 && Size != 64)
7540     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
7541 
7542   // Handle small structures.
7543   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7544     // Structures with flexible arrays have variable length, so really
7545     // fail the size test above.
7546     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
7547     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
7548       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
7549 
7550     // The structure is passed as an unextended integer, a float, or a double.
7551     llvm::Type *PassTy;
7552     if (isFPArgumentType(SingleElementTy)) {
7553       assert(Size == 32 || Size == 64);
7554       if (Size == 32)
7555         PassTy = llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext());
7556       else
7557         PassTy = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext());
7558     } else
7559       PassTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
7560     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(PassTy);
7561   }
7562 
7563   // Non-structure compounds are passed indirectly.
7564   if (isCompoundType(Ty))
7565     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
7566 
7567   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr);
7568 }
7569 
7570 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7571 // MSP430 ABI Implementation
7572 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7573 
7574 namespace {
7575 
7576 class MSP430ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
7577   static ABIArgInfo complexArgInfo() {
7578     ABIArgInfo Info = ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7579     Info.setCanBeFlattened(false);
7580     return Info;
7581   }
7582 
7583 public:
7584   MSP430ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
7585 
7586   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
7587     if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
7588       return complexArgInfo();
7589 
7590     return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
7591   }
7592 
7593   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const {
7594     if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
7595       return complexArgInfo();
7596 
7597     return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(RetTy);
7598   }
7599 
7600   // Just copy the original implementations because
7601   // DefaultABIInfo::classify{Return,Argument}Type() are not virtual
7602   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
7603     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7604       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7605     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7606       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
7607   }
7608 
7609   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7610                     QualType Ty) const override {
7611     return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty));
7612   }
7613 };
7614 
7615 class MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7616 public:
7617   MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7618       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<MSP430ABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
7619   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7620                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
7621 };
7622 
7623 }
7624 
7625 void MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
7626     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
7627   if (GV->isDeclaration())
7628     return;
7629   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7630     const auto *InterruptAttr = FD->getAttr<MSP430InterruptAttr>();
7631     if (!InterruptAttr)
7632       return;
7633 
7634     // Handle 'interrupt' attribute:
7635     llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
7636 
7637     // Step 1: Set ISR calling convention.
7638     F->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::MSP430_INTR);
7639 
7640     // Step 2: Add attributes goodness.
7641     F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
7642     F->addFnAttr("interrupt", llvm::utostr(InterruptAttr->getNumber()));
7643   }
7644 }
7645 
7646 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7647 // MIPS ABI Implementation.  This works for both little-endian and
7648 // big-endian variants.
7649 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7650 
7651 namespace {
7652 class MipsABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
7653   bool IsO32;
7654   unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes, StackAlignInBytes;
7655   void CoerceToIntArgs(uint64_t TySize,
7656                        SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const;
7657   llvm::Type* HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const;
7658   llvm::Type* returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const;
7659   llvm::Type* getPaddingType(uint64_t Align, uint64_t Offset) const;
7660 public:
7661   MipsABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool _IsO32) :
7662     ABIInfo(CGT), IsO32(_IsO32), MinABIStackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 4 : 8),
7663     StackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 8 : 16) {}
7664 
7665   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
7666   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, uint64_t &Offset) const;
7667   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
7668   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7669                     QualType Ty) const override;
7670   ABIArgInfo extendType(QualType Ty) const;
7671 };
7672 
7673 class MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7674   unsigned SizeOfUnwindException;
7675 public:
7676   MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool IsO32)
7677       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<MipsABIInfo>(CGT, IsO32)),
7678         SizeOfUnwindException(IsO32 ? 24 : 32) {}
7679 
7680   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
7681     return 29;
7682   }
7683 
7684   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7685                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
7686     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
7687     if (!FD) return;
7688     llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
7689 
7690     if (FD->hasAttr<MipsLongCallAttr>())
7691       Fn->addFnAttr("long-call");
7692     else if (FD->hasAttr<MipsShortCallAttr>())
7693       Fn->addFnAttr("short-call");
7694 
7695     // Other attributes do not have a meaning for declarations.
7696     if (GV->isDeclaration())
7697       return;
7698 
7699     if (FD->hasAttr<Mips16Attr>()) {
7700       Fn->addFnAttr("mips16");
7701     }
7702     else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMips16Attr>()) {
7703       Fn->addFnAttr("nomips16");
7704     }
7705 
7706     if (FD->hasAttr<MicroMipsAttr>())
7707       Fn->addFnAttr("micromips");
7708     else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMicroMipsAttr>())
7709       Fn->addFnAttr("nomicromips");
7710 
7711     const MipsInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<MipsInterruptAttr>();
7712     if (!Attr)
7713       return;
7714 
7715     const char *Kind;
7716     switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) {
7717     case MipsInterruptAttr::eic:     Kind = "eic"; break;
7718     case MipsInterruptAttr::sw0:     Kind = "sw0"; break;
7719     case MipsInterruptAttr::sw1:     Kind = "sw1"; break;
7720     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw0:     Kind = "hw0"; break;
7721     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw1:     Kind = "hw1"; break;
7722     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw2:     Kind = "hw2"; break;
7723     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw3:     Kind = "hw3"; break;
7724     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw4:     Kind = "hw4"; break;
7725     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw5:     Kind = "hw5"; break;
7726     }
7727 
7728     Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind);
7729 
7730   }
7731 
7732   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
7733                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
7734 
7735   unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override {
7736     return SizeOfUnwindException;
7737   }
7738 };
7739 }
7740 
7741 void MipsABIInfo::CoerceToIntArgs(
7742     uint64_t TySize, SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const {
7743   llvm::IntegerType *IntTy =
7744     llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8);
7745 
7746   // Add (TySize / MinABIStackAlignInBytes) args of IntTy.
7747   for (unsigned N = TySize / (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); N; --N)
7748     ArgList.push_back(IntTy);
7749 
7750   // If necessary, add one more integer type to ArgList.
7751   unsigned R = TySize % (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8);
7752 
7753   if (R)
7754     ArgList.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), R));
7755 }
7756 
7757 // In N32/64, an aligned double precision floating point field is passed in
7758 // a register.
7759 llvm::Type* MipsABIInfo::HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const {
7760   SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> ArgList, IntArgList;
7761 
7762   if (IsO32) {
7763     CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList);
7764     return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
7765   }
7766 
7767   if (Ty->isComplexType())
7768     return CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
7769 
7770   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
7771 
7772   // Unions/vectors are passed in integer registers.
7773   if (!RT || !RT->isStructureOrClassType()) {
7774     CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList);
7775     return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
7776   }
7777 
7778   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
7779   const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
7780   assert(!(TySize % 8) && "Size of structure must be multiple of 8.");
7781 
7782   uint64_t LastOffset = 0;
7783   unsigned idx = 0;
7784   llvm::IntegerType *I64 = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64);
7785 
7786   // Iterate over fields in the struct/class and check if there are any aligned
7787   // double fields.
7788   for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
7789        i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
7790     const QualType Ty = i->getType();
7791     const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7792 
7793     if (!BT || BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Double)
7794       continue;
7795 
7796     uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
7797     if (Offset % 64) // Ignore doubles that are not aligned.
7798       continue;
7799 
7800     // Add ((Offset - LastOffset) / 64) args of type i64.
7801     for (unsigned j = (Offset - LastOffset) / 64; j > 0; --j)
7802       ArgList.push_back(I64);
7803 
7804     // Add double type.
7805     ArgList.push_back(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()));
7806     LastOffset = Offset + 64;
7807   }
7808 
7809   CoerceToIntArgs(TySize - LastOffset, IntArgList);
7810   ArgList.append(IntArgList.begin(), IntArgList.end());
7811 
7812   return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
7813 }
7814 
7815 llvm::Type *MipsABIInfo::getPaddingType(uint64_t OrigOffset,
7816                                         uint64_t Offset) const {
7817   if (OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes > Offset)
7818     return nullptr;
7819 
7820   return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), (Offset - OrigOffset) * 8);
7821 }
7822 
7823 ABIArgInfo
7824 MipsABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint64_t &Offset) const {
7825   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
7826 
7827   uint64_t OrigOffset = Offset;
7828   uint64_t TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7829   uint64_t Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
7830 
7831   Align = std::min(std::max(Align, (uint64_t)MinABIStackAlignInBytes),
7832                    (uint64_t)StackAlignInBytes);
7833   unsigned CurrOffset = llvm::alignTo(Offset, Align);
7834   Offset = CurrOffset + llvm::alignTo(TySize, Align * 8) / 8;
7835 
7836   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isVectorType()) {
7837     // Ignore empty aggregates.
7838     if (TySize == 0)
7839       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7840 
7841     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
7842       Offset = OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
7843       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
7844     }
7845 
7846     // If we have reached here, aggregates are passed directly by coercing to
7847     // another structure type. Padding is inserted if the offset of the
7848     // aggregate is unaligned.
7849     ABIArgInfo ArgInfo =
7850         ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HandleAggregates(Ty, TySize), 0,
7851                               getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset));
7852     ArgInfo.setInReg(true);
7853     return ArgInfo;
7854   }
7855 
7856   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7857   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7858     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7859 
7860   // Make sure we pass indirectly things that are too large.
7861   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
7862     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128 ||
7863         (EIT->getNumBits() > 64 &&
7864          !getContext().getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()))
7865       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
7866 
7867   // All integral types are promoted to the GPR width.
7868   if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
7869     return extendType(Ty);
7870 
7871   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
7872       nullptr, 0, IsO32 ? nullptr : getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset));
7873 }
7874 
7875 llvm::Type*
7876 MipsABIInfo::returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const {
7877   const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>();
7878   SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> RTList;
7879 
7880   if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) {
7881     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
7882     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
7883     unsigned FieldCnt = Layout.getFieldCount();
7884 
7885     // N32/64 returns struct/classes in floating point registers if the
7886     // following conditions are met:
7887     // 1. The size of the struct/class is no larger than 128-bit.
7888     // 2. The struct/class has one or two fields all of which are floating
7889     //    point types.
7890     // 3. The offset of the first field is zero (this follows what gcc does).
7891     //
7892     // Any other composite results are returned in integer registers.
7893     //
7894     if (FieldCnt && (FieldCnt <= 2) && !Layout.getFieldOffset(0)) {
7895       RecordDecl::field_iterator b = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
7896       for (; b != e; ++b) {
7897         const BuiltinType *BT = b->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7898 
7899         if (!BT || !BT->isFloatingPoint())
7900           break;
7901 
7902         RTList.push_back(CGT.ConvertType(b->getType()));
7903       }
7904 
7905       if (b == e)
7906         return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList,
7907                                      RD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>());
7908 
7909       RTList.clear();
7910     }
7911   }
7912 
7913   CoerceToIntArgs(Size, RTList);
7914   return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList);
7915 }
7916 
7917 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
7918   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
7919 
7920   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
7921     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7922 
7923   // O32 doesn't treat zero-sized structs differently from other structs.
7924   // However, N32/N64 ignores zero sized return values.
7925   if (!IsO32 && Size == 0)
7926     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7927 
7928   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) || RetTy->isVectorType()) {
7929     if (Size <= 128) {
7930       if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
7931         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7932 
7933       // O32 returns integer vectors in registers and N32/N64 returns all small
7934       // aggregates in registers.
7935       if (!IsO32 ||
7936           (RetTy->isVectorType() && !RetTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())) {
7937         ABIArgInfo ArgInfo =
7938             ABIArgInfo::getDirect(returnAggregateInRegs(RetTy, Size));
7939         ArgInfo.setInReg(true);
7940         return ArgInfo;
7941       }
7942     }
7943 
7944     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
7945   }
7946 
7947   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7948   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
7949     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7950 
7951   // Make sure we pass indirectly things that are too large.
7952   if (const auto *EIT = RetTy->getAs<ExtIntType>())
7953     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128 ||
7954         (EIT->getNumBits() > 64 &&
7955          !getContext().getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()))
7956       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
7957 
7958   if (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy))
7959     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy);
7960 
7961   if ((RetTy->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() ||
7962       RetTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()) && Size == 32 && !IsO32)
7963     return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(RetTy);
7964 
7965   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7966 }
7967 
7968 void MipsABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7969   ABIArgInfo &RetInfo = FI.getReturnInfo();
7970   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7971     RetInfo = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7972 
7973   // Check if a pointer to an aggregate is passed as a hidden argument.
7974   uint64_t Offset = RetInfo.isIndirect() ? MinABIStackAlignInBytes : 0;
7975 
7976   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7977     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, Offset);
7978 }
7979 
7980 Address MipsABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7981                                QualType OrigTy) const {
7982   QualType Ty = OrigTy;
7983 
7984   // Integer arguments are promoted to 32-bit on O32 and 64-bit on N32/N64.
7985   // Pointers are also promoted in the same way but this only matters for N32.
7986   unsigned SlotSizeInBits = IsO32 ? 32 : 64;
7987   unsigned PtrWidth = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0);
7988   bool DidPromote = false;
7989   if ((Ty->isIntegerType() &&
7990           getContext().getIntWidth(Ty) < SlotSizeInBits) ||
7991       (Ty->isPointerType() && PtrWidth < SlotSizeInBits)) {
7992     DidPromote = true;
7993     Ty = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(SlotSizeInBits,
7994                                             Ty->isSignedIntegerType());
7995   }
7996 
7997   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
7998 
7999   // The alignment of things in the argument area is never larger than
8000   // StackAlignInBytes.
8001   TyInfo.Align =
8002     std::min(TyInfo.Align, CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlignInBytes));
8003 
8004   // MinABIStackAlignInBytes is the size of argument slots on the stack.
8005   CharUnits ArgSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(MinABIStackAlignInBytes);
8006 
8007   Address Addr = emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
8008                           TyInfo, ArgSlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
8009 
8010 
8011   // If there was a promotion, "unpromote" into a temporary.
8012   // TODO: can we just use a pointer into a subset of the original slot?
8013   if (DidPromote) {
8014     Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(OrigTy, "vaarg.promotion-temp");
8015     llvm::Value *Promoted = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr);
8016 
8017     // Truncate down to the right width.
8018     llvm::Type *IntTy = (OrigTy->isIntegerType() ? Temp.getElementType()
8019                                                  : CGF.IntPtrTy);
8020     llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateTrunc(Promoted, IntTy);
8021     if (OrigTy->isPointerType())
8022       V = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(V, Temp.getElementType());
8023 
8024     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, Temp);
8025     Addr = Temp;
8026   }
8027 
8028   return Addr;
8029 }
8030 
8031 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::extendType(QualType Ty) const {
8032   int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
8033 
8034   // MIPS64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended.
8035   if (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32)
8036     return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(Ty);
8037 
8038   return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
8039 }
8040 
8041 bool
8042 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
8043                                                llvm::Value *Address) const {
8044   // This information comes from gcc's implementation, which seems to
8045   // as canonical as it gets.
8046 
8047   // Everything on MIPS is 4 bytes.  Double-precision FP registers
8048   // are aliased to pairs of single-precision FP registers.
8049   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
8050 
8051   // 0-31 are the general purpose registers, $0 - $31.
8052   // 32-63 are the floating-point registers, $f0 - $f31.
8053   // 64 and 65 are the multiply/divide registers, $hi and $lo.
8054   // 66 is the (notional, I think) register for signal-handler return.
8055   AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 65);
8056 
8057   // 67-74 are the floating-point status registers, $fcc0 - $fcc7.
8058   // They are one bit wide and ignored here.
8059 
8060   // 80-111 are the coprocessor 0 registers, $c0r0 - $c0r31.
8061   // (coprocessor 1 is the FP unit)
8062   // 112-143 are the coprocessor 2 registers, $c2r0 - $c2r31.
8063   // 144-175 are the coprocessor 3 registers, $c3r0 - $c3r31.
8064   // 176-181 are the DSP accumulator registers.
8065   AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 80, 181);
8066   return false;
8067 }
8068 
8069 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8070 // AVR ABI Implementation.
8071 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8072 
8073 namespace {
8074 class AVRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
8075 public:
8076   AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8077       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<DefaultABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
8078 
8079   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
8080                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
8081     if (GV->isDeclaration())
8082       return;
8083     const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
8084     if (!FD) return;
8085     auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
8086 
8087     if (FD->getAttr<AVRInterruptAttr>())
8088       Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt");
8089 
8090     if (FD->getAttr<AVRSignalAttr>())
8091       Fn->addFnAttr("signal");
8092   }
8093 };
8094 }
8095 
8096 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8097 // TCE ABI Implementation (see http://tce.cs.tut.fi). Uses mostly the defaults.
8098 // Currently subclassed only to implement custom OpenCL C function attribute
8099 // handling.
8100 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8101 
8102 namespace {
8103 
8104 class TCETargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo {
8105 public:
8106   TCETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8107     : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {}
8108 
8109   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
8110                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
8111 };
8112 
8113 void TCETargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
8114     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
8115   if (GV->isDeclaration())
8116     return;
8117   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
8118   if (!FD) return;
8119 
8120   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
8121 
8122   if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8123     if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8124       // OpenCL C Kernel functions are not subject to inlining
8125       F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
8126       const ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>();
8127       if (Attr) {
8128         // Convert the reqd_work_group_size() attributes to metadata.
8129         llvm::LLVMContext &Context = F->getContext();
8130         llvm::NamedMDNode *OpenCLMetadata =
8131             M.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata(
8132                 "opencl.kernel_wg_size_info");
8133 
8134         SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 5> Operands;
8135         Operands.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F));
8136 
8137         Operands.push_back(
8138             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
8139                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getXDim()))));
8140         Operands.push_back(
8141             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
8142                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getYDim()))));
8143         Operands.push_back(
8144             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
8145                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getZDim()))));
8146 
8147         // Add a boolean constant operand for "required" (true) or "hint"
8148         // (false) for implementing the work_group_size_hint attr later.
8149         // Currently always true as the hint is not yet implemented.
8150         Operands.push_back(
8151             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::getTrue(Context)));
8152         OpenCLMetadata->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Context, Operands));
8153       }
8154     }
8155   }
8156 }
8157 
8158 }
8159 
8160 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8161 // Hexagon ABI Implementation
8162 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8163 
8164 namespace {
8165 
8166 class HexagonABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
8167 public:
8168   HexagonABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
8169 
8170 private:
8171   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
8172   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
8173   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, unsigned *RegsLeft) const;
8174 
8175   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
8176 
8177   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
8178                     QualType Ty) const override;
8179   Address EmitVAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CFG, Address VAListAddr,
8180                               QualType Ty) const;
8181   Address EmitVAArgForHexagon(CodeGenFunction &CFG, Address VAListAddr,
8182                               QualType Ty) const;
8183   Address EmitVAArgForHexagonLinux(CodeGenFunction &CFG, Address VAListAddr,
8184                                    QualType Ty) const;
8185 };
8186 
8187 class HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
8188 public:
8189   HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8190       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<HexagonABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
8191 
8192   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
8193     return 29;
8194   }
8195 
8196   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
8197                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &GCM) const override {
8198     if (GV->isDeclaration())
8199       return;
8200     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
8201     if (!FD)
8202       return;
8203   }
8204 };
8205 
8206 } // namespace
8207 
8208 void HexagonABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
8209   unsigned RegsLeft = 6;
8210   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
8211     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
8212   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
8213     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, &RegsLeft);
8214 }
8215 
8216 static bool HexagonAdjustRegsLeft(uint64_t Size, unsigned *RegsLeft) {
8217   assert(Size <= 64 && "Not expecting to pass arguments larger than 64 bits"
8218                        " through registers");
8219 
8220   if (*RegsLeft == 0)
8221     return false;
8222 
8223   if (Size <= 32) {
8224     (*RegsLeft)--;
8225     return true;
8226   }
8227 
8228   if (2 <= (*RegsLeft & (~1U))) {
8229     *RegsLeft = (*RegsLeft & (~1U)) - 2;
8230     return true;
8231   }
8232 
8233   // Next available register was r5 but candidate was greater than 32-bits so it
8234   // has to go on the stack. However we still consume r5
8235   if (*RegsLeft == 1)
8236     *RegsLeft = 0;
8237 
8238   return false;
8239 }
8240 
8241 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
8242                                                 unsigned *RegsLeft) const {
8243   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
8244     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
8245     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
8246       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8247 
8248     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
8249     if (Size <= 64)
8250       HexagonAdjustRegsLeft(Size, RegsLeft);
8251 
8252     if (Size > 64 && Ty->isExtIntType())
8253       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
8254 
8255     return isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty)
8256                                              : ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
8257   }
8258 
8259   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
8260     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
8261 
8262   // Ignore empty records.
8263   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
8264     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8265 
8266   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
8267   unsigned Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty);
8268 
8269   if (Size > 64)
8270     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
8271 
8272   if (HexagonAdjustRegsLeft(Size, RegsLeft))
8273     Align = Size <= 32 ? 32 : 64;
8274   if (Size <= Align) {
8275     // Pass in the smallest viable integer type.
8276     if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Size))
8277       Size = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Size);
8278     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getIntNTy(getVMContext(), Size));
8279   }
8280   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
8281 }
8282 
8283 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
8284   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
8285     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8286 
8287   const TargetInfo &T = CGT.getTarget();
8288   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
8289 
8290   if (RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
8291     // HVX vectors are returned in vector registers or register pairs.
8292     if (T.hasFeature("hvx")) {
8293       assert(T.hasFeature("hvx-length64b") || T.hasFeature("hvx-length128b"));
8294       uint64_t VecSize = T.hasFeature("hvx-length64b") ? 64*8 : 128*8;
8295       if (Size == VecSize || Size == 2*VecSize)
8296         return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
8297     }
8298     // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
8299     if (Size > 64)
8300       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
8301   }
8302 
8303   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
8304     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
8305     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
8306       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8307 
8308     if (Size > 64 && RetTy->isExtIntType())
8309       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false);
8310 
8311     return isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(RetTy) ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend(RetTy)
8312                                                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
8313   }
8314 
8315   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
8316     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8317 
8318   // Aggregates <= 8 bytes are returned in registers, other aggregates
8319   // are returned indirectly.
8320   if (Size <= 64) {
8321     // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
8322     if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Size))
8323       Size = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Size);
8324     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getIntNTy(getVMContext(), Size));
8325   }
8326   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/true);
8327 }
8328 
8329 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
8330                                             Address VAListAddr,
8331                                             QualType Ty) const {
8332   // Load the overflow area pointer.
8333   Address __overflow_area_pointer_p =
8334       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "__overflow_area_pointer_p");
8335   llvm::Value *__overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
8336       __overflow_area_pointer_p, "__overflow_area_pointer");
8337 
8338   uint64_t Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
8339   if (Align > 4) {
8340     // Alignment should be a power of 2.
8341     assert((Align & (Align - 1)) == 0 && "Alignment is not power of 2!");
8342 
8343     // overflow_arg_area = (overflow_arg_area + align - 1) & -align;
8344     llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1);
8345 
8346     // Add offset to the current pointer to access the argument.
8347     __overflow_area_pointer =
8348         CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(__overflow_area_pointer, Offset);
8349     llvm::Value *AsInt =
8350         CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(__overflow_area_pointer, CGF.Int32Ty);
8351 
8352     // Create a mask which should be "AND"ed
8353     // with (overflow_arg_area + align - 1)
8354     llvm::Value *Mask = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -(int)Align);
8355     __overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(
8356         CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(AsInt, Mask), __overflow_area_pointer->getType(),
8357         "__overflow_area_pointer.align");
8358   }
8359 
8360   // Get the type of the argument from memory and bitcast
8361   // overflow area pointer to the argument type.
8362   llvm::Type *PTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
8363   Address AddrTyped = CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(
8364       Address(__overflow_area_pointer, CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align)),
8365       llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(PTy));
8366 
8367   // Round up to the minimum stack alignment for varargs which is 4 bytes.
8368   uint64_t Offset = llvm::alignTo(CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) / 8, 4);
8369 
8370   __overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(
8371       __overflow_area_pointer, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Offset),
8372       "__overflow_area_pointer.next");
8373   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(__overflow_area_pointer, __overflow_area_pointer_p);
8374 
8375   return AddrTyped;
8376 }
8377 
8378 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArgForHexagon(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
8379                                             Address VAListAddr,
8380                                             QualType Ty) const {
8381   // FIXME: Need to handle alignment
8382   llvm::Type *BP = CGF.Int8PtrTy;
8383   llvm::Type *BPP = CGF.Int8PtrPtrTy;
8384   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
8385   Address VAListAddrAsBPP = Builder.CreateBitCast(VAListAddr, BPP, "ap");
8386   llvm::Value *Addr = Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddrAsBPP, "ap.cur");
8387   // Handle address alignment for type alignment > 32 bits
8388   uint64_t TyAlign = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
8389   if (TyAlign > 4) {
8390     assert((TyAlign & (TyAlign - 1)) == 0 && "Alignment is not power of 2!");
8391     llvm::Value *AddrAsInt = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(Addr, CGF.Int32Ty);
8392     AddrAsInt = Builder.CreateAdd(AddrAsInt, Builder.getInt32(TyAlign - 1));
8393     AddrAsInt = Builder.CreateAnd(AddrAsInt, Builder.getInt32(~(TyAlign - 1)));
8394     Addr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrAsInt, BP);
8395   }
8396   llvm::Type *PTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertType(Ty));
8397   Address AddrTyped = Builder.CreateBitCast(
8398       Address(Addr, CharUnits::fromQuantity(TyAlign)), PTy);
8399 
8400   uint64_t Offset = llvm::alignTo(CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) / 8, 4);
8401   llvm::Value *NextAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(
8402       Addr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Offset), "ap.next");
8403   Builder.CreateStore(NextAddr, VAListAddrAsBPP);
8404 
8405   return AddrTyped;
8406 }
8407 
8408 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArgForHexagonLinux(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
8409                                                  Address VAListAddr,
8410                                                  QualType Ty) const {
8411   int ArgSize = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) / 8;
8412 
8413   if (ArgSize > 8)
8414     return EmitVAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
8415 
8416   // Here we have check if the argument is in register area or
8417   // in overflow area.
8418   // If the saved register area pointer + argsize rounded up to alignment >
8419   // saved register area end pointer, argument is in overflow area.
8420   unsigned RegsLeft = 6;
8421   Ty = CGF.getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty);
8422   (void)classifyArgumentType(Ty, &RegsLeft);
8423 
8424   llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg");
8425   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
8426   llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack");
8427   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
8428 
8429   // Get rounded size of the argument.GCC does not allow vararg of
8430   // size < 4 bytes. We follow the same logic here.
8431   ArgSize = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32) ? 4 : 8;
8432   int ArgAlign = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32) ? 4 : 8;
8433 
8434   // Argument may be in saved register area
8435   CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock);
8436 
8437   // Load the current saved register area pointer.
8438   Address __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(
8439       VAListAddr, 0, "__current_saved_reg_area_pointer_p");
8440   llvm::Value *__current_saved_reg_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
8441       __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_p, "__current_saved_reg_area_pointer");
8442 
8443   // Load the saved register area end pointer.
8444   Address __saved_reg_area_end_pointer_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(
8445       VAListAddr, 1, "__saved_reg_area_end_pointer_p");
8446   llvm::Value *__saved_reg_area_end_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
8447       __saved_reg_area_end_pointer_p, "__saved_reg_area_end_pointer");
8448 
8449   // If the size of argument is > 4 bytes, check if the stack
8450   // location is aligned to 8 bytes
8451   if (ArgAlign > 4) {
8452 
8453     llvm::Value *__current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int =
8454         CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(__current_saved_reg_area_pointer,
8455                                    CGF.Int32Ty);
8456 
8457     __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
8458         __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int,
8459         llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (ArgAlign - 1)),
8460         "align_current_saved_reg_area_pointer");
8461 
8462     __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int =
8463         CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(__current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int,
8464                               llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -ArgAlign),
8465                               "align_current_saved_reg_area_pointer");
8466 
8467     __current_saved_reg_area_pointer =
8468         CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(__current_saved_reg_area_pointer_int,
8469                                    __current_saved_reg_area_pointer->getType(),
8470                                    "align_current_saved_reg_area_pointer");
8471   }
8472 
8473   llvm::Value *__new_saved_reg_area_pointer =
8474       CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(__current_saved_reg_area_pointer,
8475                             llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, ArgSize),
8476                             "__new_saved_reg_area_pointer");
8477 
8478   llvm::Value *UsingStack = 0;
8479   UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGT(__new_saved_reg_area_pointer,
8480                                          __saved_reg_area_end_pointer);
8481 
8482   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, InRegBlock);
8483 
8484   // Argument in saved register area
8485   // Implement the block where argument is in register saved area
8486   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
8487 
8488   llvm::Type *PTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
8489   llvm::Value *__saved_reg_area_p = CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(
8490       __current_saved_reg_area_pointer, llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(PTy));
8491 
8492   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(__new_saved_reg_area_pointer,
8493                           __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_p);
8494 
8495   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
8496 
8497   // Argument in overflow area
8498   // Implement the block where the argument is in overflow area.
8499   CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock);
8500 
8501   // Load the overflow area pointer
8502   Address __overflow_area_pointer_p =
8503       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, "__overflow_area_pointer_p");
8504   llvm::Value *__overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
8505       __overflow_area_pointer_p, "__overflow_area_pointer");
8506 
8507   // Align the overflow area pointer according to the alignment of the argument
8508   if (ArgAlign > 4) {
8509     llvm::Value *__overflow_area_pointer_int =
8510         CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(__overflow_area_pointer, CGF.Int32Ty);
8511 
8512     __overflow_area_pointer_int =
8513         CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(__overflow_area_pointer_int,
8514                               llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, ArgAlign - 1),
8515                               "align_overflow_area_pointer");
8516 
8517     __overflow_area_pointer_int =
8518         CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(__overflow_area_pointer_int,
8519                               llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -ArgAlign),
8520                               "align_overflow_area_pointer");
8521 
8522     __overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(
8523         __overflow_area_pointer_int, __overflow_area_pointer->getType(),
8524         "align_overflow_area_pointer");
8525   }
8526 
8527   // Get the pointer for next argument in overflow area and store it
8528   // to overflow area pointer.
8529   llvm::Value *__new_overflow_area_pointer = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(
8530       __overflow_area_pointer, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, ArgSize),
8531       "__overflow_area_pointer.next");
8532 
8533   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(__new_overflow_area_pointer,
8534                           __overflow_area_pointer_p);
8535 
8536   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(__new_overflow_area_pointer,
8537                           __current_saved_reg_area_pointer_p);
8538 
8539   // Bitcast the overflow area pointer to the type of argument.
8540   llvm::Type *OverflowPTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
8541   llvm::Value *__overflow_area_p = CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(
8542       __overflow_area_pointer, llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(OverflowPTy));
8543 
8544   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
8545 
8546   // Get the correct pointer to load the variable argument
8547   // Implement the ContBlock
8548   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
8549 
8550   llvm::Type *MemPTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
8551   llvm::PHINode *ArgAddr = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(MemPTy, 2, "vaarg.addr");
8552   ArgAddr->addIncoming(__saved_reg_area_p, InRegBlock);
8553   ArgAddr->addIncoming(__overflow_area_p, OnStackBlock);
8554 
8555   return Address(ArgAddr, CharUnits::fromQuantity(ArgAlign));
8556 }
8557 
8558 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
8559                                   QualType Ty) const {
8560 
8561   if (getTarget().getTriple().isMusl())
8562     return EmitVAArgForHexagonLinux(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
8563 
8564   return EmitVAArgForHexagon(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
8565 }
8566 
8567 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8568 // Lanai ABI Implementation
8569 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8570 
8571 namespace {
8572 class LanaiABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
8573 public:
8574   LanaiABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
8575 
8576   bool shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
8577 
8578   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
8579     CCState State(FI);
8580     // Lanai uses 4 registers to pass arguments unless the function has the
8581     // regparm attribute set.
8582     if (FI.getHasRegParm()) {
8583       State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm();
8584     } else {
8585       State.FreeRegs = 4;
8586     }
8587 
8588     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
8589       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
8590     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
8591       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State);
8592   }
8593 
8594   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const;
8595   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
8596 };
8597 } // end anonymous namespace
8598 
8599 bool LanaiABIInfo::shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
8600   unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
8601   unsigned SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(Size, 32U) / 32U;
8602 
8603   if (SizeInRegs == 0)
8604     return false;
8605 
8606   if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) {
8607     State.FreeRegs = 0;
8608     return false;
8609   }
8610 
8611   State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
8612 
8613   return true;
8614 }
8615 
8616 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal,
8617                                            CCState &State) const {
8618   if (!ByVal) {
8619     if (State.FreeRegs) {
8620       --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer.
8621       return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty);
8622     }
8623     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false);
8624   }
8625 
8626   // Compute the byval alignment.
8627   const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4;
8628   unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
8629   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true,
8630                                  /*Realign=*/TypeAlign >
8631                                      MinABIStackAlignInBytes);
8632 }
8633 
8634 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
8635                                               CCState &State) const {
8636   // Check with the C++ ABI first.
8637   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
8638   if (RT) {
8639     CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI());
8640     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) {
8641       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
8642     } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) {
8643       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
8644     }
8645   }
8646 
8647   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
8648     // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
8649     if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
8650       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State);
8651 
8652     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
8653     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
8654       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8655 
8656     llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext();
8657     unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
8658     if (SizeInRegs <= State.FreeRegs) {
8659       llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext);
8660       SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32);
8661       llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements);
8662       State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
8663       return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result);
8664     } else {
8665       State.FreeRegs = 0;
8666     }
8667     return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
8668   }
8669 
8670   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
8671   if (const auto *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
8672     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
8673 
8674   bool InReg = shouldUseInReg(Ty, State);
8675 
8676   // Don't pass >64 bit integers in registers.
8677   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
8678     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
8679       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State);
8680 
8681   if (isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty)) {
8682     if (InReg)
8683       return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
8684     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
8685   }
8686   if (InReg)
8687     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
8688   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
8689 }
8690 
8691 namespace {
8692 class LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
8693 public:
8694   LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8695       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<LanaiABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
8696 };
8697 }
8698 
8699 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8700 // AMDGPU ABI Implementation
8701 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8702 
8703 namespace {
8704 
8705 class AMDGPUABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo {
8706 private:
8707   static const unsigned MaxNumRegsForArgsRet = 16;
8708 
8709   unsigned numRegsForType(QualType Ty) const;
8710 
8711   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
8712   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
8713                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
8714 
8715   // Coerce HIP pointer arguments from generic pointers to global ones.
8716   llvm::Type *coerceKernelArgumentType(llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned FromAS,
8717                                        unsigned ToAS) const {
8718     // Structure types.
8719     if (auto STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(Ty)) {
8720       SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 8> EltTys;
8721       bool Changed = false;
8722       for (auto T : STy->elements()) {
8723         auto NT = coerceKernelArgumentType(T, FromAS, ToAS);
8724         EltTys.push_back(NT);
8725         Changed |= (NT != T);
8726       }
8727       // Skip if there is no change in element types.
8728       if (!Changed)
8729         return STy;
8730       if (STy->hasName())
8731         return llvm::StructType::create(
8732             EltTys, (STy->getName() + ".coerce").str(), STy->isPacked());
8733       return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), EltTys, STy->isPacked());
8734     }
8735     // Array types.
8736     if (auto ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(Ty)) {
8737       auto T = ATy->getElementType();
8738       auto NT = coerceKernelArgumentType(T, FromAS, ToAS);
8739       // Skip if there is no change in that element type.
8740       if (NT == T)
8741         return ATy;
8742       return llvm::ArrayType::get(NT, ATy->getNumElements());
8743     }
8744     // Single value types.
8745     if (Ty->isPointerTy() && Ty->getPointerAddressSpace() == FromAS)
8746       return llvm::PointerType::get(
8747           cast<llvm::PointerType>(Ty)->getElementType(), ToAS);
8748     return Ty;
8749   }
8750 
8751 public:
8752   explicit AMDGPUABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) :
8753     DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
8754 
8755   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
8756   ABIArgInfo classifyKernelArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
8757   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NumRegsLeft) const;
8758 
8759   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
8760   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
8761                     QualType Ty) const override;
8762 };
8763 
8764 bool AMDGPUABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
8765   return true;
8766 }
8767 
8768 bool AMDGPUABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(
8769   const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const {
8770   uint32_t NumRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 31) / 32;
8771 
8772   // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 16 registers.
8773   return Members * NumRegs <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet;
8774 }
8775 
8776 /// Estimate number of registers the type will use when passed in registers.
8777 unsigned AMDGPUABIInfo::numRegsForType(QualType Ty) const {
8778   unsigned NumRegs = 0;
8779 
8780   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
8781     // Compute from the number of elements. The reported size is based on the
8782     // in-memory size, which includes the padding 4th element for 3-vectors.
8783     QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType();
8784     unsigned EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy);
8785 
8786     // 16-bit element vectors should be passed as packed.
8787     if (EltSize == 16)
8788       return (VT->getNumElements() + 1) / 2;
8789 
8790     unsigned EltNumRegs = (EltSize + 31) / 32;
8791     return EltNumRegs * VT->getNumElements();
8792   }
8793 
8794   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8795     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
8796     assert(!RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember());
8797 
8798     for (const FieldDecl *Field : RD->fields()) {
8799       QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
8800       NumRegs += numRegsForType(FieldTy);
8801     }
8802 
8803     return NumRegs;
8804   }
8805 
8806   return (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
8807 }
8808 
8809 void AMDGPUABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
8810   llvm::CallingConv::ID CC = FI.getCallingConvention();
8811 
8812   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
8813     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
8814 
8815   unsigned NumRegsLeft = MaxNumRegsForArgsRet;
8816   for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments()) {
8817     if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL) {
8818       Arg.info = classifyKernelArgumentType(Arg.type);
8819     } else {
8820       Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type, NumRegsLeft);
8821     }
8822   }
8823 }
8824 
8825 Address AMDGPUABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
8826                                  QualType Ty) const {
8827   llvm_unreachable("AMDGPU does not support varargs");
8828 }
8829 
8830 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
8831   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
8832     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
8833     // returned by value.
8834     if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) {
8835       // Ignore empty structs/unions.
8836       if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
8837         return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8838 
8839       // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value.
8840       if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext()))
8841         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
8842 
8843       if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8844         const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
8845         if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
8846           return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
8847       }
8848 
8849       // Pack aggregates <= 4 bytes into single VGPR or pair.
8850       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
8851       if (Size <= 16)
8852         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
8853 
8854       if (Size <= 32)
8855         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
8856 
8857       if (Size <= 64) {
8858         llvm::Type *I32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
8859         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(I32Ty, 2));
8860       }
8861 
8862       if (numRegsForType(RetTy) <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet)
8863         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
8864     }
8865   }
8866 
8867   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
8868   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
8869 }
8870 
8871 /// For kernels all parameters are really passed in a special buffer. It doesn't
8872 /// make sense to pass anything byval, so everything must be direct.
8873 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyKernelArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
8874   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
8875 
8876   // TODO: Can we omit empty structs?
8877 
8878   if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
8879     Ty = QualType(SeltTy, 0);
8880 
8881   llvm::Type *OrigLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
8882   llvm::Type *LTy = OrigLTy;
8883   if (getContext().getLangOpts().HIP) {
8884     LTy = coerceKernelArgumentType(
8885         OrigLTy, /*FromAS=*/getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::Default),
8886         /*ToAS=*/getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::cuda_device));
8887   }
8888 
8889   // FIXME: Should also use this for OpenCL, but it requires addressing the
8890   // problem of kernels being called.
8891   //
8892   // FIXME: This doesn't apply the optimization of coercing pointers in structs
8893   // to global address space when using byref. This would require implementing a
8894   // new kind of coercion of the in-memory type when for indirect arguments.
8895   if (!getContext().getLangOpts().OpenCL && LTy == OrigLTy &&
8896       isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
8897     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectAliased(
8898         getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty),
8899         getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_constant),
8900         false /*Realign*/, nullptr /*Padding*/);
8901   }
8902 
8903   // If we set CanBeFlattened to true, CodeGen will expand the struct to its
8904   // individual elements, which confuses the Clover OpenCL backend; therefore we
8905   // have to set it to false here. Other args of getDirect() are just defaults.
8906   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(LTy, 0, nullptr, false);
8907 }
8908 
8909 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
8910                                                unsigned &NumRegsLeft) const {
8911   assert(NumRegsLeft <= MaxNumRegsForArgsRet && "register estimate underflow");
8912 
8913   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
8914 
8915   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
8916     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
8917     // passed by value.
8918     if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
8919       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
8920 
8921     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
8922     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
8923       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
8924 
8925     // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We
8926     // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(),
8927     // though watch out for things like bitfields.
8928     if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
8929       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
8930 
8931     if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8932       const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
8933       if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
8934         return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
8935     }
8936 
8937     // Pack aggregates <= 8 bytes into single VGPR or pair.
8938     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
8939     if (Size <= 64) {
8940       unsigned NumRegs = (Size + 31) / 32;
8941       NumRegsLeft -= std::min(NumRegsLeft, NumRegs);
8942 
8943       if (Size <= 16)
8944         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
8945 
8946       if (Size <= 32)
8947         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
8948 
8949       // XXX: Should this be i64 instead, and should the limit increase?
8950       llvm::Type *I32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
8951       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(I32Ty, 2));
8952     }
8953 
8954     if (NumRegsLeft > 0) {
8955       unsigned NumRegs = numRegsForType(Ty);
8956       if (NumRegsLeft >= NumRegs) {
8957         NumRegsLeft -= NumRegs;
8958         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
8959       }
8960     }
8961   }
8962 
8963   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
8964   ABIArgInfo ArgInfo = DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
8965   if (!ArgInfo.isIndirect()) {
8966     unsigned NumRegs = numRegsForType(Ty);
8967     NumRegsLeft -= std::min(NumRegs, NumRegsLeft);
8968   }
8969 
8970   return ArgInfo;
8971 }
8972 
8973 class AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
8974 public:
8975   AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8976       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<AMDGPUABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
8977   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
8978                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
8979   unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override;
8980 
8981   llvm::Constant *getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8982       llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const override;
8983 
8984   LangAS getASTAllocaAddressSpace() const override {
8985     return getLangASFromTargetAS(
8986         getABIInfo().getDataLayout().getAllocaAddrSpace());
8987   }
8988   LangAS getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
8989                                   const VarDecl *D) const override;
8990   llvm::SyncScope::ID getLLVMSyncScopeID(const LangOptions &LangOpts,
8991                                          SyncScope Scope,
8992                                          llvm::AtomicOrdering Ordering,
8993                                          llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx) const override;
8994   llvm::Function *
8995   createEnqueuedBlockKernel(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
8996                             llvm::Function *BlockInvokeFunc,
8997                             llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const override;
8998   bool shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const override;
8999   void setCUDAKernelCallingConvention(const FunctionType *&FT) const override;
9000 };
9001 }
9002 
9003 static bool requiresAMDGPUProtectedVisibility(const Decl *D,
9004                                               llvm::GlobalValue *GV) {
9005   if (GV->getVisibility() != llvm::GlobalValue::HiddenVisibility)
9006     return false;
9007 
9008   return D->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>() ||
9009          (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) && D->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) ||
9010          (isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
9011           (D->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() || D->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>() ||
9012            cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType()->isCUDADeviceBuiltinSurfaceType() ||
9013            cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType()->isCUDADeviceBuiltinTextureType()));
9014 }
9015 
9016 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
9017     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
9018   if (requiresAMDGPUProtectedVisibility(D, GV)) {
9019     GV->setVisibility(llvm::GlobalValue::ProtectedVisibility);
9020     GV->setDSOLocal(true);
9021   }
9022 
9023   if (GV->isDeclaration())
9024     return;
9025   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
9026   if (!FD)
9027     return;
9028 
9029   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
9030 
9031   const auto *ReqdWGS = M.getLangOpts().OpenCL ?
9032     FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>() : nullptr;
9033 
9034 
9035   const bool IsOpenCLKernel = M.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
9036                               FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>();
9037   const bool IsHIPKernel = M.getLangOpts().HIP &&
9038                            FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>();
9039   if ((IsOpenCLKernel || IsHIPKernel) &&
9040       (M.getTriple().getOS() == llvm::Triple::AMDHSA))
9041     F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-implicitarg-num-bytes", "56");
9042 
9043   if (IsHIPKernel)
9044     F->addFnAttr("uniform-work-group-size", "true");
9045 
9046 
9047   const auto *FlatWGS = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUFlatWorkGroupSizeAttr>();
9048   if (ReqdWGS || FlatWGS) {
9049     unsigned Min = 0;
9050     unsigned Max = 0;
9051     if (FlatWGS) {
9052       Min = FlatWGS->getMin()
9053                 ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext())
9054                 .getExtValue();
9055       Max = FlatWGS->getMax()
9056                 ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext())
9057                 .getExtValue();
9058     }
9059     if (ReqdWGS && Min == 0 && Max == 0)
9060       Min = Max = ReqdWGS->getXDim() * ReqdWGS->getYDim() * ReqdWGS->getZDim();
9061 
9062     if (Min != 0) {
9063       assert(Min <= Max && "Min must be less than or equal Max");
9064 
9065       std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min) + "," + llvm::utostr(Max);
9066       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-flat-work-group-size", AttrVal);
9067     } else
9068       assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero");
9069   } else if (IsOpenCLKernel || IsHIPKernel) {
9070     // By default, restrict the maximum size to a value specified by
9071     // --gpu-max-threads-per-block=n or its default value.
9072     std::string AttrVal =
9073         std::string("1,") + llvm::utostr(M.getLangOpts().GPUMaxThreadsPerBlock);
9074     F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-flat-work-group-size", AttrVal);
9075   }
9076 
9077   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUWavesPerEUAttr>()) {
9078     unsigned Min =
9079         Attr->getMin()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext()).getExtValue();
9080     unsigned Max = Attr->getMax() ? Attr->getMax()
9081                                         ->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext())
9082                                         .getExtValue()
9083                                   : 0;
9084 
9085     if (Min != 0) {
9086       assert((Max == 0 || Min <= Max) && "Min must be less than or equal Max");
9087 
9088       std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min);
9089       if (Max != 0)
9090         AttrVal = AttrVal + "," + llvm::utostr(Max);
9091       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-waves-per-eu", AttrVal);
9092     } else
9093       assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero");
9094   }
9095 
9096   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumSGPRAttr>()) {
9097     unsigned NumSGPR = Attr->getNumSGPR();
9098 
9099     if (NumSGPR != 0)
9100       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-sgpr", llvm::utostr(NumSGPR));
9101   }
9102 
9103   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumVGPRAttr>()) {
9104     uint32_t NumVGPR = Attr->getNumVGPR();
9105 
9106     if (NumVGPR != 0)
9107       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-vgpr", llvm::utostr(NumVGPR));
9108   }
9109 }
9110 
9111 unsigned AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
9112   return llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL;
9113 }
9114 
9115 // Currently LLVM assumes null pointers always have value 0,
9116 // which results in incorrectly transformed IR. Therefore, instead of
9117 // emitting null pointers in private and local address spaces, a null
9118 // pointer in generic address space is emitted which is casted to a
9119 // pointer in local or private address space.
9120 llvm::Constant *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(
9121     const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::PointerType *PT,
9122     QualType QT) const {
9123   if (CGM.getContext().getTargetNullPointerValue(QT) == 0)
9124     return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(PT);
9125 
9126   auto &Ctx = CGM.getContext();
9127   auto NPT = llvm::PointerType::get(PT->getElementType(),
9128       Ctx.getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic));
9129   return llvm::ConstantExpr::getAddrSpaceCast(
9130       llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(NPT), PT);
9131 }
9132 
9133 LangAS
9134 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
9135                                                   const VarDecl *D) const {
9136   assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
9137          !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) &&
9138          "Address space agnostic languages only");
9139   LangAS DefaultGlobalAS = getLangASFromTargetAS(
9140       CGM.getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global));
9141   if (!D)
9142     return DefaultGlobalAS;
9143 
9144   LangAS AddrSpace = D->getType().getAddressSpace();
9145   assert(AddrSpace == LangAS::Default || isTargetAddressSpace(AddrSpace));
9146   if (AddrSpace != LangAS::Default)
9147     return AddrSpace;
9148 
9149   if (CGM.isTypeConstant(D->getType(), false)) {
9150     if (auto ConstAS = CGM.getTarget().getConstantAddressSpace())
9151       return ConstAS.getValue();
9152   }
9153   return DefaultGlobalAS;
9154 }
9155 
9156 llvm::SyncScope::ID
9157 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getLLVMSyncScopeID(const LangOptions &LangOpts,
9158                                             SyncScope Scope,
9159                                             llvm::AtomicOrdering Ordering,
9160                                             llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx) const {
9161   std::string Name;
9162   switch (Scope) {
9163   case SyncScope::OpenCLWorkGroup:
9164     Name = "workgroup";
9165     break;
9166   case SyncScope::OpenCLDevice:
9167     Name = "agent";
9168     break;
9169   case SyncScope::OpenCLAllSVMDevices:
9170     Name = "";
9171     break;
9172   case SyncScope::OpenCLSubGroup:
9173     Name = "wavefront";
9174   }
9175 
9176   if (Ordering != llvm::AtomicOrdering::SequentiallyConsistent) {
9177     if (!Name.empty())
9178       Name = Twine(Twine(Name) + Twine("-")).str();
9179 
9180     Name = Twine(Twine(Name) + Twine("one-as")).str();
9181   }
9182 
9183   return Ctx.getOrInsertSyncScopeID(Name);
9184 }
9185 
9186 bool AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::shouldEmitStaticExternCAliases() const {
9187   return false;
9188 }
9189 
9190 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setCUDAKernelCallingConvention(
9191     const FunctionType *&FT) const {
9192   FT = getABIInfo().getContext().adjustFunctionType(
9193       FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_OpenCLKernel));
9194 }
9195 
9196 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9197 // SPARC v8 ABI Implementation.
9198 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1.
9199 //
9200 // Ensures that complex values are passed in registers.
9201 //
9202 namespace {
9203 class SparcV8ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
9204 public:
9205   SparcV8ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
9206 
9207 private:
9208   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
9209   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
9210 };
9211 } // end anonymous namespace
9212 
9213 
9214 ABIArgInfo
9215 SparcV8ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const {
9216   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) {
9217     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
9218   }
9219   else {
9220     return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty);
9221   }
9222 }
9223 
9224 void SparcV8ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
9225 
9226   FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
9227   for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
9228     Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
9229 }
9230 
9231 namespace {
9232 class SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
9233 public:
9234   SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
9235       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<SparcV8ABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
9236 };
9237 } // end anonymous namespace
9238 
9239 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9240 // SPARC v9 ABI Implementation.
9241 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1.
9242 //
9243 // Function arguments a mapped to a nominal "parameter array" and promoted to
9244 // registers depending on their type. Each argument occupies 8 or 16 bytes in
9245 // the array, structs larger than 16 bytes are passed indirectly.
9246 //
9247 // One case requires special care:
9248 //
9249 //   struct mixed {
9250 //     int i;
9251 //     float f;
9252 //   };
9253 //
9254 // When a struct mixed is passed by value, it only occupies 8 bytes in the
9255 // parameter array, but the int is passed in an integer register, and the float
9256 // is passed in a floating point register. This is represented as two arguments
9257 // with the LLVM IR inreg attribute:
9258 //
9259 //   declare void f(i32 inreg %i, float inreg %f)
9260 //
9261 // The code generator will only allocate 4 bytes from the parameter array for
9262 // the inreg arguments. All other arguments are allocated a multiple of 8
9263 // bytes.
9264 //
9265 namespace {
9266 class SparcV9ABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
9267 public:
9268   SparcV9ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
9269 
9270 private:
9271   ABIArgInfo classifyType(QualType RetTy, unsigned SizeLimit) const;
9272   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
9273   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9274                     QualType Ty) const override;
9275 
9276   // Coercion type builder for structs passed in registers. The coercion type
9277   // serves two purposes:
9278   //
9279   // 1. Pad structs to a multiple of 64 bits, so they are passed 'left-aligned'
9280   //    in registers.
9281   // 2. Expose aligned floating point elements as first-level elements, so the
9282   //    code generator knows to pass them in floating point registers.
9283   //
9284   // We also compute the InReg flag which indicates that the struct contains
9285   // aligned 32-bit floats.
9286   //
9287   struct CoerceBuilder {
9288     llvm::LLVMContext &Context;
9289     const llvm::DataLayout &DL;
9290     SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> Elems;
9291     uint64_t Size;
9292     bool InReg;
9293 
9294     CoerceBuilder(llvm::LLVMContext &c, const llvm::DataLayout &dl)
9295       : Context(c), DL(dl), Size(0), InReg(false) {}
9296 
9297     // Pad Elems with integers until Size is ToSize.
9298     void pad(uint64_t ToSize) {
9299       assert(ToSize >= Size && "Cannot remove elements");
9300       if (ToSize == Size)
9301         return;
9302 
9303       // Finish the current 64-bit word.
9304       uint64_t Aligned = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64);
9305       if (Aligned > Size && Aligned <= ToSize) {
9306         Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, Aligned - Size));
9307         Size = Aligned;
9308       }
9309 
9310       // Add whole 64-bit words.
9311       while (Size + 64 <= ToSize) {
9312         Elems.push_back(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Context));
9313         Size += 64;
9314       }
9315 
9316       // Final in-word padding.
9317       if (Size < ToSize) {
9318         Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, ToSize - Size));
9319         Size = ToSize;
9320       }
9321     }
9322 
9323     // Add a floating point element at Offset.
9324     void addFloat(uint64_t Offset, llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned Bits) {
9325       // Unaligned floats are treated as integers.
9326       if (Offset % Bits)
9327         return;
9328       // The InReg flag is only required if there are any floats < 64 bits.
9329       if (Bits < 64)
9330         InReg = true;
9331       pad(Offset);
9332       Elems.push_back(Ty);
9333       Size = Offset + Bits;
9334     }
9335 
9336     // Add a struct type to the coercion type, starting at Offset (in bits).
9337     void addStruct(uint64_t Offset, llvm::StructType *StrTy) {
9338       const llvm::StructLayout *Layout = DL.getStructLayout(StrTy);
9339       for (unsigned i = 0, e = StrTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
9340         llvm::Type *ElemTy = StrTy->getElementType(i);
9341         uint64_t ElemOffset = Offset + Layout->getElementOffsetInBits(i);
9342         switch (ElemTy->getTypeID()) {
9343         case llvm::Type::StructTyID:
9344           addStruct(ElemOffset, cast<llvm::StructType>(ElemTy));
9345           break;
9346         case llvm::Type::FloatTyID:
9347           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 32);
9348           break;
9349         case llvm::Type::DoubleTyID:
9350           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 64);
9351           break;
9352         case llvm::Type::FP128TyID:
9353           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 128);
9354           break;
9355         case llvm::Type::PointerTyID:
9356           if (ElemOffset % 64 == 0) {
9357             pad(ElemOffset);
9358             Elems.push_back(ElemTy);
9359             Size += 64;
9360           }
9361           break;
9362         default:
9363           break;
9364         }
9365       }
9366     }
9367 
9368     // Check if Ty is a usable substitute for the coercion type.
9369     bool isUsableType(llvm::StructType *Ty) const {
9370       return llvm::makeArrayRef(Elems) == Ty->elements();
9371     }
9372 
9373     // Get the coercion type as a literal struct type.
9374     llvm::Type *getType() const {
9375       if (Elems.size() == 1)
9376         return Elems.front();
9377       else
9378         return llvm::StructType::get(Context, Elems);
9379     }
9380   };
9381 };
9382 } // end anonymous namespace
9383 
9384 ABIArgInfo
9385 SparcV9ABIInfo::classifyType(QualType Ty, unsigned SizeLimit) const {
9386   if (Ty->isVoidType())
9387     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
9388 
9389   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
9390 
9391   // Anything too big to fit in registers is passed with an explicit indirect
9392   // pointer / sret pointer.
9393   if (Size > SizeLimit)
9394     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
9395 
9396   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
9397   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
9398     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
9399 
9400   // Integer types smaller than a register are extended.
9401   if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType())
9402     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
9403 
9404   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
9405     if (EIT->getNumBits() < 64)
9406       return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
9407 
9408   // Other non-aggregates go in registers.
9409   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty))
9410     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
9411 
9412   // If a C++ object has either a non-trivial copy constructor or a non-trivial
9413   // destructor, it is passed with an explicit indirect pointer / sret pointer.
9414   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
9415     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
9416 
9417   // This is a small aggregate type that should be passed in registers.
9418   // Build a coercion type from the LLVM struct type.
9419   llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty));
9420   if (!StrTy)
9421     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
9422 
9423   CoerceBuilder CB(getVMContext(), getDataLayout());
9424   CB.addStruct(0, StrTy);
9425   CB.pad(llvm::alignTo(CB.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StrTy), 64));
9426 
9427   // Try to use the original type for coercion.
9428   llvm::Type *CoerceTy = CB.isUsableType(StrTy) ? StrTy : CB.getType();
9429 
9430   if (CB.InReg)
9431     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CoerceTy);
9432   else
9433     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
9434 }
9435 
9436 Address SparcV9ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9437                                   QualType Ty) const {
9438   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyType(Ty, 16 * 8);
9439   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
9440   if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType())
9441     AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy);
9442 
9443   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
9444 
9445   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
9446   Address Addr(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize);
9447   llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy);
9448 
9449   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
9450 
9451   Address ArgAddr = Address::invalid();
9452   CharUnits Stride;
9453   switch (AI.getKind()) {
9454   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
9455   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
9456   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
9457     llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg");
9458 
9459   case ABIArgInfo::Extend: {
9460     Stride = SlotSize;
9461     CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TypeInfo.Width;
9462     ArgAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Offset, "extend");
9463     break;
9464   }
9465 
9466   case ABIArgInfo::Direct: {
9467     auto AllocSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType());
9468     Stride = CharUnits::fromQuantity(AllocSize).alignTo(SlotSize);
9469     ArgAddr = Addr;
9470     break;
9471   }
9472 
9473   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
9474   case ABIArgInfo::IndirectAliased:
9475     Stride = SlotSize;
9476     ArgAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, ArgPtrTy, "indirect");
9477     ArgAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(ArgAddr, "indirect.arg"),
9478                       TypeInfo.Align);
9479     break;
9480 
9481   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
9482     return Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeInfo.Align);
9483   }
9484 
9485   // Update VAList.
9486   Address NextPtr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Stride, "ap.next");
9487   Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr.getPointer(), VAListAddr);
9488 
9489   return Builder.CreateBitCast(ArgAddr, ArgPtrTy, "arg.addr");
9490 }
9491 
9492 void SparcV9ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
9493   FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyType(FI.getReturnType(), 32 * 8);
9494   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
9495     I.info = classifyType(I.type, 16 * 8);
9496 }
9497 
9498 namespace {
9499 class SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
9500 public:
9501   SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
9502       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<SparcV9ABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
9503 
9504   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
9505     return 14;
9506   }
9507 
9508   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
9509                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
9510 };
9511 } // end anonymous namespace
9512 
9513 bool
9514 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
9515                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
9516   // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified
9517   // against gcc output.  AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding.
9518 
9519   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
9520 
9521   llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty;
9522   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4);
9523   llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8);
9524 
9525   // 0-31: the 8-byte general-purpose registers
9526   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31);
9527 
9528   // 32-63: f0-31, the 4-byte floating-point registers
9529   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 32, 63);
9530 
9531   //   Y   = 64
9532   //   PSR = 65
9533   //   WIM = 66
9534   //   TBR = 67
9535   //   PC  = 68
9536   //   NPC = 69
9537   //   FSR = 70
9538   //   CSR = 71
9539   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 71);
9540 
9541   // 72-87: d0-15, the 8-byte floating-point registers
9542   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 72, 87);
9543 
9544   return false;
9545 }
9546 
9547 // ARC ABI implementation.
9548 namespace {
9549 
9550 class ARCABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
9551 public:
9552   using DefaultABIInfo::DefaultABIInfo;
9553 
9554 private:
9555   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9556                     QualType Ty) const override;
9557 
9558   void updateState(const ABIArgInfo &Info, QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
9559     if (!State.FreeRegs)
9560       return;
9561     if (Info.isIndirect() && Info.getInReg())
9562       State.FreeRegs--;
9563     else if (Info.isDirect() && Info.getInReg()) {
9564       unsigned sz = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
9565       if (sz < State.FreeRegs)
9566         State.FreeRegs -= sz;
9567       else
9568         State.FreeRegs = 0;
9569     }
9570   }
9571 
9572   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
9573     CCState State(FI);
9574     // ARC uses 8 registers to pass arguments.
9575     State.FreeRegs = 8;
9576 
9577     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
9578       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
9579     updateState(FI.getReturnInfo(), FI.getReturnType(), State);
9580     for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
9581       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State.FreeRegs);
9582       updateState(I.info, I.type, State);
9583     }
9584   }
9585 
9586   ABIArgInfo getIndirectByRef(QualType Ty, bool HasFreeRegs) const;
9587   ABIArgInfo getIndirectByValue(QualType Ty) const;
9588   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint8_t FreeRegs) const;
9589   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
9590 };
9591 
9592 class ARCTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
9593 public:
9594   ARCTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
9595       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<ARCABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
9596 };
9597 
9598 
9599 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::getIndirectByRef(QualType Ty, bool HasFreeRegs) const {
9600   return HasFreeRegs ? getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty) :
9601                        getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false);
9602 }
9603 
9604 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::getIndirectByValue(QualType Ty) const {
9605   // Compute the byval alignment.
9606   const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4;
9607   unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
9608   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true,
9609                                  TypeAlign > MinABIStackAlignInBytes);
9610 }
9611 
9612 Address ARCABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9613                               QualType Ty) const {
9614   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
9615                           getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
9616                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), true);
9617 }
9618 
9619 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
9620                                             uint8_t FreeRegs) const {
9621   // Handle the generic C++ ABI.
9622   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
9623   if (RT) {
9624     CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI());
9625     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect)
9626       return getIndirectByRef(Ty, FreeRegs > 0);
9627 
9628     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory)
9629       return getIndirectByValue(Ty);
9630   }
9631 
9632   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
9633   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
9634     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
9635 
9636   auto SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty), 32) / 32;
9637 
9638   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
9639     // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
9640     if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
9641       return getIndirectByValue(Ty);
9642 
9643     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
9644     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
9645       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
9646 
9647     llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext();
9648 
9649     llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext);
9650     SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32);
9651     llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements);
9652 
9653     return FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ?
9654         ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result) :
9655         ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result, 0, nullptr, false);
9656   }
9657 
9658   if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>())
9659     if (EIT->getNumBits() > 64)
9660       return getIndirectByValue(Ty);
9661 
9662   return isPromotableIntegerTypeForABI(Ty)
9663              ? (FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ? ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg(Ty)
9664                                        : ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty))
9665              : (FreeRegs >= SizeInRegs ? ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg()
9666                                        : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
9667 }
9668 
9669 ABIArgInfo ARCABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
9670   if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
9671     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
9672 
9673   // Arguments of size > 4 registers are indirect.
9674   auto RetSize = llvm::alignTo(getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy), 32) / 32;
9675   if (RetSize > 4)
9676     return getIndirectByRef(RetTy, /*HasFreeRegs*/ true);
9677 
9678   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
9679 }
9680 
9681 } // End anonymous namespace.
9682 
9683 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9684 // XCore ABI Implementation
9685 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9686 
9687 namespace {
9688 
9689 /// A SmallStringEnc instance is used to build up the TypeString by passing
9690 /// it by reference between functions that append to it.
9691 typedef llvm::SmallString<128> SmallStringEnc;
9692 
9693 /// TypeStringCache caches the meta encodings of Types.
9694 ///
9695 /// The reason for caching TypeStrings is two fold:
9696 ///   1. To cache a type's encoding for later uses;
9697 ///   2. As a means to break recursive member type inclusion.
9698 ///
9699 /// A cache Entry can have a Status of:
9700 ///   NonRecursive:   The type encoding is not recursive;
9701 ///   Recursive:      The type encoding is recursive;
9702 ///   Incomplete:     An incomplete TypeString;
9703 ///   IncompleteUsed: An incomplete TypeString that has been used in a
9704 ///                   Recursive type encoding.
9705 ///
9706 /// A NonRecursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully
9707 /// as possible. Whilst it may contain types which are recursive, the type
9708 /// itself is not recursive and thus its encoding may be safely used whenever
9709 /// the type is encountered.
9710 ///
9711 /// A Recursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully as
9712 /// possible. The type itself is recursive and it may contain other types which
9713 /// are recursive. The Recursive encoding must not be used during the expansion
9714 /// of a recursive type's recursive branch. For simplicity the code uses
9715 /// IncompleteCount to reject all usage of Recursive encodings for member types.
9716 ///
9717 /// An Incomplete entry is always a RecordType and only encodes its
9718 /// identifier e.g. "s(S){}". Incomplete 'StubEnc' entries are ephemeral and
9719 /// are placed into the cache during type expansion as a means to identify and
9720 /// handle recursive inclusion of types as sub-members. If there is recursion
9721 /// the entry becomes IncompleteUsed.
9722 ///
9723 /// During the expansion of a RecordType's members:
9724 ///
9725 ///   If the cache contains a NonRecursive encoding for the member type, the
9726 ///   cached encoding is used;
9727 ///
9728 ///   If the cache contains a Recursive encoding for the member type, the
9729 ///   cached encoding is 'Swapped' out, as it may be incorrect, and...
9730 ///
9731 ///   If the member is a RecordType, an Incomplete encoding is placed into the
9732 ///   cache to break potential recursive inclusion of itself as a sub-member;
9733 ///
9734 ///   Once a member RecordType has been expanded, its temporary incomplete
9735 ///   entry is removed from the cache. If a Recursive encoding was swapped out
9736 ///   it is swapped back in;
9737 ///
9738 ///   If an incomplete entry is used to expand a sub-member, the incomplete
9739 ///   entry is marked as IncompleteUsed. The cache keeps count of how many
9740 ///   IncompleteUsed entries it currently contains in IncompleteUsedCount;
9741 ///
9742 ///   If a member's encoding is found to be a NonRecursive or Recursive viz:
9743 ///   IncompleteUsedCount==0, the member's encoding is added to the cache.
9744 ///   Else the member is part of a recursive type and thus the recursion has
9745 ///   been exited too soon for the encoding to be correct for the member.
9746 ///
9747 class TypeStringCache {
9748   enum Status {NonRecursive, Recursive, Incomplete, IncompleteUsed};
9749   struct Entry {
9750     std::string Str;     // The encoded TypeString for the type.
9751     enum Status State;   // Information about the encoding in 'Str'.
9752     std::string Swapped; // A temporary place holder for a Recursive encoding
9753                          // during the expansion of RecordType's members.
9754   };
9755   std::map<const IdentifierInfo *, struct Entry> Map;
9756   unsigned IncompleteCount;     // Number of Incomplete entries in the Map.
9757   unsigned IncompleteUsedCount; // Number of IncompleteUsed entries in the Map.
9758 public:
9759   TypeStringCache() : IncompleteCount(0), IncompleteUsedCount(0) {}
9760   void addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, std::string StubEnc);
9761   bool removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID);
9762   void addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str,
9763                      bool IsRecursive);
9764   StringRef lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID);
9765 };
9766 
9767 /// TypeString encodings for enum & union fields must be order.
9768 /// FieldEncoding is a helper for this ordering process.
9769 class FieldEncoding {
9770   bool HasName;
9771   std::string Enc;
9772 public:
9773   FieldEncoding(bool b, SmallStringEnc &e) : HasName(b), Enc(e.c_str()) {}
9774   StringRef str() { return Enc; }
9775   bool operator<(const FieldEncoding &rhs) const {
9776     if (HasName != rhs.HasName) return HasName;
9777     return Enc < rhs.Enc;
9778   }
9779 };
9780 
9781 class XCoreABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
9782 public:
9783   XCoreABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
9784   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9785                     QualType Ty) const override;
9786 };
9787 
9788 class XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
9789   mutable TypeStringCache TSC;
9790   void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
9791                     const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const;
9792 
9793 public:
9794   XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
9795       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<XCoreABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
9796   void emitTargetMetadata(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
9797                           const llvm::MapVector<GlobalDecl, StringRef>
9798                               &MangledDeclNames) const override;
9799 };
9800 
9801 } // End anonymous namespace.
9802 
9803 // TODO: this implementation is likely now redundant with the default
9804 // EmitVAArg.
9805 Address XCoreABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
9806                                 QualType Ty) const {
9807   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
9808 
9809   // Get the VAList.
9810   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
9811   Address AP(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize);
9812 
9813   // Handle the argument.
9814   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
9815   CharUnits TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
9816   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
9817   if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType())
9818     AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy);
9819   llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy);
9820 
9821   Address Val = Address::invalid();
9822   CharUnits ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero();
9823   switch (AI.getKind()) {
9824   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
9825   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
9826   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
9827     llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg");
9828   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
9829     Val = Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeAlign);
9830     ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero();
9831     break;
9832   case ABIArgInfo::Extend:
9833   case ABIArgInfo::Direct:
9834     Val = Builder.CreateBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy);
9835     ArgSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(
9836                        getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType()));
9837     ArgSize = ArgSize.alignTo(SlotSize);
9838     break;
9839   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
9840   case ABIArgInfo::IndirectAliased:
9841     Val = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy);
9842     Val = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Val), TypeAlign);
9843     ArgSize = SlotSize;
9844     break;
9845   }
9846 
9847   // Increment the VAList.
9848   if (!ArgSize.isZero()) {
9849     Address APN = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(AP, ArgSize);
9850     Builder.CreateStore(APN.getPointer(), VAListAddr);
9851   }
9852 
9853   return Val;
9854 }
9855 
9856 /// During the expansion of a RecordType, an incomplete TypeString is placed
9857 /// into the cache as a means to identify and break recursion.
9858 /// If there is a Recursive encoding in the cache, it is swapped out and will
9859 /// be reinserted by removeIncomplete().
9860 /// All other types of encoding should have been used rather than arriving here.
9861 void TypeStringCache::addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID,
9862                                     std::string StubEnc) {
9863   if (!ID)
9864     return;
9865   Entry &E = Map[ID];
9866   assert( (E.Str.empty() || E.State == Recursive) &&
9867          "Incorrectly use of addIncomplete");
9868   assert(!StubEnc.empty() && "Passing an empty string to addIncomplete()");
9869   E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); // swap out the Recursive
9870   E.Str.swap(StubEnc);
9871   E.State = Incomplete;
9872   ++IncompleteCount;
9873 }
9874 
9875 /// Once the RecordType has been expanded, the temporary incomplete TypeString
9876 /// must be removed from the cache.
9877 /// If a Recursive was swapped out by addIncomplete(), it will be replaced.
9878 /// Returns true if the RecordType was defined recursively.
9879 bool TypeStringCache::removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
9880   if (!ID)
9881     return false;
9882   auto I = Map.find(ID);
9883   assert(I != Map.end() && "Entry not present");
9884   Entry &E = I->second;
9885   assert( (E.State == Incomplete ||
9886            E.State == IncompleteUsed) &&
9887          "Entry must be an incomplete type");
9888   bool IsRecursive = false;
9889   if (E.State == IncompleteUsed) {
9890     // We made use of our Incomplete encoding, thus we are recursive.
9891     IsRecursive = true;
9892     --IncompleteUsedCount;
9893   }
9894   if (E.Swapped.empty())
9895     Map.erase(I);
9896   else {
9897     // Swap the Recursive back.
9898     E.Swapped.swap(E.Str);
9899     E.Swapped.clear();
9900     E.State = Recursive;
9901   }
9902   --IncompleteCount;
9903   return IsRecursive;
9904 }
9905 
9906 /// Add the encoded TypeString to the cache only if it is NonRecursive or
9907 /// Recursive (viz: all sub-members were expanded as fully as possible).
9908 void TypeStringCache::addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str,
9909                                     bool IsRecursive) {
9910   if (!ID || IncompleteUsedCount)
9911     return; // No key or it is is an incomplete sub-type so don't add.
9912   Entry &E = Map[ID];
9913   if (IsRecursive && !E.Str.empty()) {
9914     assert(E.State==Recursive && E.Str.size() == Str.size() &&
9915            "This is not the same Recursive entry");
9916     // The parent container was not recursive after all, so we could have used
9917     // this Recursive sub-member entry after all, but we assumed the worse when
9918     // we started viz: IncompleteCount!=0.
9919     return;
9920   }
9921   assert(E.Str.empty() && "Entry already present");
9922   E.Str = Str.str();
9923   E.State = IsRecursive? Recursive : NonRecursive;
9924 }
9925 
9926 /// Return a cached TypeString encoding for the ID. If there isn't one, or we
9927 /// are recursively expanding a type (IncompleteCount != 0) and the cached
9928 /// encoding is Recursive, return an empty StringRef.
9929 StringRef TypeStringCache::lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
9930   if (!ID)
9931     return StringRef();   // We have no key.
9932   auto I = Map.find(ID);
9933   if (I == Map.end())
9934     return StringRef();   // We have no encoding.
9935   Entry &E = I->second;
9936   if (E.State == Recursive && IncompleteCount)
9937     return StringRef();   // We don't use Recursive encodings for member types.
9938 
9939   if (E.State == Incomplete) {
9940     // The incomplete type is being used to break out of recursion.
9941     E.State = IncompleteUsed;
9942     ++IncompleteUsedCount;
9943   }
9944   return E.Str;
9945 }
9946 
9947 /// The XCore ABI includes a type information section that communicates symbol
9948 /// type information to the linker. The linker uses this information to verify
9949 /// safety/correctness of things such as array bound and pointers et al.
9950 /// The ABI only requires C (and XC) language modules to emit TypeStrings.
9951 /// This type information (TypeString) is emitted into meta data for all global
9952 /// symbols: definitions, declarations, functions & variables.
9953 ///
9954 /// The TypeString carries type, qualifier, name, size & value details.
9955 /// Please see 'Tools Development Guide' section 2.16.2 for format details:
9956 /// https://www.xmos.com/download/public/Tools-Development-Guide%28X9114A%29.pdf
9957 /// The output is tested by test/CodeGen/xcore-stringtype.c.
9958 ///
9959 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D,
9960                           const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
9961                           TypeStringCache &TSC);
9962 
9963 /// XCore uses emitTargetMD to emit TypeString metadata for global symbols.
9964 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(
9965     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
9966     const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
9967   SmallStringEnc Enc;
9968   if (getTypeString(Enc, D, CGM, TSC)) {
9969     llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext();
9970     llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV),
9971                                 llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Enc.str())};
9972     llvm::NamedMDNode *MD =
9973       CGM.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata("xcore.typestrings");
9974     MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals));
9975   }
9976 }
9977 
9978 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMetadata(
9979     CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
9980     const llvm::MapVector<GlobalDecl, StringRef> &MangledDeclNames) const {
9981   // Warning, new MangledDeclNames may be appended within this loop.
9982   // We rely on MapVector insertions adding new elements to the end
9983   // of the container.
9984   for (unsigned I = 0; I != MangledDeclNames.size(); ++I) {
9985     auto Val = *(MangledDeclNames.begin() + I);
9986     llvm::GlobalValue *GV = CGM.GetGlobalValue(Val.second);
9987     if (GV) {
9988       const Decl *D = Val.first.getDecl()->getMostRecentDecl();
9989       emitTargetMD(D, GV, CGM);
9990     }
9991   }
9992 }
9993 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9994 // SPIR ABI Implementation
9995 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9996 
9997 namespace {
9998 class SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
9999 public:
10000   SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
10001       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<DefaultABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
10002   unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override;
10003 };
10004 
10005 } // End anonymous namespace.
10006 
10007 namespace clang {
10008 namespace CodeGen {
10009 void computeSPIRKernelABIInfo(CodeGenModule &CGM, CGFunctionInfo &FI) {
10010   DefaultABIInfo SPIRABI(CGM.getTypes());
10011   SPIRABI.computeInfo(FI);
10012 }
10013 }
10014 }
10015 
10016 unsigned SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
10017   return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL;
10018 }
10019 
10020 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType,
10021                        const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10022                        TypeStringCache &TSC);
10023 
10024 /// Helper function for appendRecordType().
10025 /// Builds a SmallVector containing the encoded field types in declaration
10026 /// order.
10027 static bool extractFieldType(SmallVectorImpl<FieldEncoding> &FE,
10028                              const RecordDecl *RD,
10029                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10030                              TypeStringCache &TSC) {
10031   for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
10032     SmallStringEnc Enc;
10033     Enc += "m(";
10034     Enc += Field->getName();
10035     Enc += "){";
10036     if (Field->isBitField()) {
10037       Enc += "b(";
10038       llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Enc);
10039       OS << Field->getBitWidthValue(CGM.getContext());
10040       Enc += ':';
10041     }
10042     if (!appendType(Enc, Field->getType(), CGM, TSC))
10043       return false;
10044     if (Field->isBitField())
10045       Enc += ')';
10046     Enc += '}';
10047     FE.emplace_back(!Field->getName().empty(), Enc);
10048   }
10049   return true;
10050 }
10051 
10052 /// Appends structure and union types to Enc and adds encoding to cache.
10053 /// Recursively calls appendType (via extractFieldType) for each field.
10054 /// Union types have their fields ordered according to the ABI.
10055 static bool appendRecordType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const RecordType *RT,
10056                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10057                              TypeStringCache &TSC, const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
10058   // Append the cached TypeString if we have one.
10059   StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID);
10060   if (!TypeString.empty()) {
10061     Enc += TypeString;
10062     return true;
10063   }
10064 
10065   // Start to emit an incomplete TypeString.
10066   size_t Start = Enc.size();
10067   Enc += (RT->isUnionType()? 'u' : 's');
10068   Enc += '(';
10069   if (ID)
10070     Enc += ID->getName();
10071   Enc += "){";
10072 
10073   // We collect all encoded fields and order as necessary.
10074   bool IsRecursive = false;
10075   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl()->getDefinition();
10076   if (RD && !RD->field_empty()) {
10077     // An incomplete TypeString stub is placed in the cache for this RecordType
10078     // so that recursive calls to this RecordType will use it whilst building a
10079     // complete TypeString for this RecordType.
10080     SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE;
10081     std::string StubEnc(Enc.substr(Start).str());
10082     StubEnc += '}';  // StubEnc now holds a valid incomplete TypeString.
10083     TSC.addIncomplete(ID, std::move(StubEnc));
10084     if (!extractFieldType(FE, RD, CGM, TSC)) {
10085       (void) TSC.removeIncomplete(ID);
10086       return false;
10087     }
10088     IsRecursive = TSC.removeIncomplete(ID);
10089     // The ABI requires unions to be sorted but not structures.
10090     // See FieldEncoding::operator< for sort algorithm.
10091     if (RT->isUnionType())
10092       llvm::sort(FE);
10093     // We can now complete the TypeString.
10094     unsigned E = FE.size();
10095     for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) {
10096       if (I)
10097         Enc += ',';
10098       Enc += FE[I].str();
10099     }
10100   }
10101   Enc += '}';
10102   TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), IsRecursive);
10103   return true;
10104 }
10105 
10106 /// Appends enum types to Enc and adds the encoding to the cache.
10107 static bool appendEnumType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const EnumType *ET,
10108                            TypeStringCache &TSC,
10109                            const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
10110   // Append the cached TypeString if we have one.
10111   StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID);
10112   if (!TypeString.empty()) {
10113     Enc += TypeString;
10114     return true;
10115   }
10116 
10117   size_t Start = Enc.size();
10118   Enc += "e(";
10119   if (ID)
10120     Enc += ID->getName();
10121   Enc += "){";
10122 
10123   // We collect all encoded enumerations and order them alphanumerically.
10124   if (const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl()->getDefinition()) {
10125     SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE;
10126     for (auto I = ED->enumerator_begin(), E = ED->enumerator_end(); I != E;
10127          ++I) {
10128       SmallStringEnc EnumEnc;
10129       EnumEnc += "m(";
10130       EnumEnc += I->getName();
10131       EnumEnc += "){";
10132       I->getInitVal().toString(EnumEnc);
10133       EnumEnc += '}';
10134       FE.push_back(FieldEncoding(!I->getName().empty(), EnumEnc));
10135     }
10136     llvm::sort(FE);
10137     unsigned E = FE.size();
10138     for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) {
10139       if (I)
10140         Enc += ',';
10141       Enc += FE[I].str();
10142     }
10143   }
10144   Enc += '}';
10145   TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), false);
10146   return true;
10147 }
10148 
10149 /// Appends type's qualifier to Enc.
10150 /// This is done prior to appending the type's encoding.
10151 static void appendQualifier(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT) {
10152   // Qualifiers are emitted in alphabetical order.
10153   static const char *const Table[]={"","c:","r:","cr:","v:","cv:","rv:","crv:"};
10154   int Lookup = 0;
10155   if (QT.isConstQualified())
10156     Lookup += 1<<0;
10157   if (QT.isRestrictQualified())
10158     Lookup += 1<<1;
10159   if (QT.isVolatileQualified())
10160     Lookup += 1<<2;
10161   Enc += Table[Lookup];
10162 }
10163 
10164 /// Appends built-in types to Enc.
10165 static bool appendBuiltinType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const BuiltinType *BT) {
10166   const char *EncType;
10167   switch (BT->getKind()) {
10168     case BuiltinType::Void:
10169       EncType = "0";
10170       break;
10171     case BuiltinType::Bool:
10172       EncType = "b";
10173       break;
10174     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
10175       EncType = "uc";
10176       break;
10177     case BuiltinType::UChar:
10178       EncType = "uc";
10179       break;
10180     case BuiltinType::SChar:
10181       EncType = "sc";
10182       break;
10183     case BuiltinType::UShort:
10184       EncType = "us";
10185       break;
10186     case BuiltinType::Short:
10187       EncType = "ss";
10188       break;
10189     case BuiltinType::UInt:
10190       EncType = "ui";
10191       break;
10192     case BuiltinType::Int:
10193       EncType = "si";
10194       break;
10195     case BuiltinType::ULong:
10196       EncType = "ul";
10197       break;
10198     case BuiltinType::Long:
10199       EncType = "sl";
10200       break;
10201     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
10202       EncType = "ull";
10203       break;
10204     case BuiltinType::LongLong:
10205       EncType = "sll";
10206       break;
10207     case BuiltinType::Float:
10208       EncType = "ft";
10209       break;
10210     case BuiltinType::Double:
10211       EncType = "d";
10212       break;
10213     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
10214       EncType = "ld";
10215       break;
10216     default:
10217       return false;
10218   }
10219   Enc += EncType;
10220   return true;
10221 }
10222 
10223 /// Appends a pointer encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the pointee.
10224 static bool appendPointerType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const PointerType *PT,
10225                               const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10226                               TypeStringCache &TSC) {
10227   Enc += "p(";
10228   if (!appendType(Enc, PT->getPointeeType(), CGM, TSC))
10229     return false;
10230   Enc += ')';
10231   return true;
10232 }
10233 
10234 /// Appends array encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the element.
10235 static bool appendArrayType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT,
10236                             const ArrayType *AT,
10237                             const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10238                             TypeStringCache &TSC, StringRef NoSizeEnc) {
10239   if (AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Normal)
10240     return false;
10241   Enc += "a(";
10242   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
10243     CAT->getSize().toStringUnsigned(Enc);
10244   else
10245     Enc += NoSizeEnc; // Global arrays use "*", otherwise it is "".
10246   Enc += ':';
10247   // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
10248   appendQualifier(Enc, QT);
10249   if (!appendType(Enc, AT->getElementType(), CGM, TSC))
10250     return false;
10251   Enc += ')';
10252   return true;
10253 }
10254 
10255 /// Appends a function encoding to Enc, calling appendType for the return type
10256 /// and the arguments.
10257 static bool appendFunctionType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const FunctionType *FT,
10258                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10259                              TypeStringCache &TSC) {
10260   Enc += "f{";
10261   if (!appendType(Enc, FT->getReturnType(), CGM, TSC))
10262     return false;
10263   Enc += "}(";
10264   if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10265     // N.B. we are only interested in the adjusted param types.
10266     auto I = FPT->param_type_begin();
10267     auto E = FPT->param_type_end();
10268     if (I != E) {
10269       do {
10270         if (!appendType(Enc, *I, CGM, TSC))
10271           return false;
10272         ++I;
10273         if (I != E)
10274           Enc += ',';
10275       } while (I != E);
10276       if (FPT->isVariadic())
10277         Enc += ",va";
10278     } else {
10279       if (FPT->isVariadic())
10280         Enc += "va";
10281       else
10282         Enc += '0';
10283     }
10284   }
10285   Enc += ')';
10286   return true;
10287 }
10288 
10289 /// Handles the type's qualifier before dispatching a call to handle specific
10290 /// type encodings.
10291 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType,
10292                        const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10293                        TypeStringCache &TSC) {
10294 
10295   QualType QT = QType.getCanonicalType();
10296 
10297   if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
10298     // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
10299     // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here.
10300     return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "");
10301 
10302   appendQualifier(Enc, QT);
10303 
10304   if (const BuiltinType *BT = QT->getAs<BuiltinType>())
10305     return appendBuiltinType(Enc, BT);
10306 
10307   if (const PointerType *PT = QT->getAs<PointerType>())
10308     return appendPointerType(Enc, PT, CGM, TSC);
10309 
10310   if (const EnumType *ET = QT->getAs<EnumType>())
10311     return appendEnumType(Enc, ET, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
10312 
10313   if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsStructureType())
10314     return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
10315 
10316   if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsUnionType())
10317     return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
10318 
10319   if (const FunctionType *FT = QT->getAs<FunctionType>())
10320     return appendFunctionType(Enc, FT, CGM, TSC);
10321 
10322   return false;
10323 }
10324 
10325 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D,
10326                           const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
10327                           TypeStringCache &TSC) {
10328   if (!D)
10329     return false;
10330 
10331   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
10332     if (FD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage)
10333       return false;
10334     return appendType(Enc, FD->getType(), CGM, TSC);
10335   }
10336 
10337   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
10338     if (VD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage)
10339       return false;
10340     QualType QT = VD->getType().getCanonicalType();
10341     if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) {
10342       // Global ArrayTypes are given a size of '*' if the size is unknown.
10343       // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
10344       // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here.
10345       return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "*");
10346     }
10347     return appendType(Enc, QT, CGM, TSC);
10348   }
10349   return false;
10350 }
10351 
10352 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10353 // RISCV ABI Implementation
10354 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10355 
10356 namespace {
10357 class RISCVABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
10358 private:
10359   // Size of the integer ('x') registers in bits.
10360   unsigned XLen;
10361   // Size of the floating point ('f') registers in bits. Note that the target
10362   // ISA might have a wider FLen than the selected ABI (e.g. an RV32IF target
10363   // with soft float ABI has FLen==0).
10364   unsigned FLen;
10365   static const int NumArgGPRs = 8;
10366   static const int NumArgFPRs = 8;
10367   bool detectFPCCEligibleStructHelper(QualType Ty, CharUnits CurOff,
10368                                       llvm::Type *&Field1Ty,
10369                                       CharUnits &Field1Off,
10370                                       llvm::Type *&Field2Ty,
10371                                       CharUnits &Field2Off) const;
10372 
10373 public:
10374   RISCVABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, unsigned XLen, unsigned FLen)
10375       : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), XLen(XLen), FLen(FLen) {}
10376 
10377   // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are
10378   // non-virtual, but computeInfo is virtual, so we overload it.
10379   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
10380 
10381   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, bool IsFixed, int &ArgGPRsLeft,
10382                                   int &ArgFPRsLeft) const;
10383   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
10384 
10385   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
10386                     QualType Ty) const override;
10387 
10388   ABIArgInfo extendType(QualType Ty) const;
10389 
10390   bool detectFPCCEligibleStruct(QualType Ty, llvm::Type *&Field1Ty,
10391                                 CharUnits &Field1Off, llvm::Type *&Field2Ty,
10392                                 CharUnits &Field2Off, int &NeededArgGPRs,
10393                                 int &NeededArgFPRs) const;
10394   ABIArgInfo coerceAndExpandFPCCEligibleStruct(llvm::Type *Field1Ty,
10395                                                CharUnits Field1Off,
10396                                                llvm::Type *Field2Ty,
10397                                                CharUnits Field2Off) const;
10398 };
10399 } // end anonymous namespace
10400 
10401 void RISCVABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
10402   QualType RetTy = FI.getReturnType();
10403   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
10404     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(RetTy);
10405 
10406   // IsRetIndirect is true if classifyArgumentType indicated the value should
10407   // be passed indirect, or if the type size is a scalar greater than 2*XLen
10408   // and not a complex type with elements <= FLen. e.g. fp128 is passed direct
10409   // in LLVM IR, relying on the backend lowering code to rewrite the argument
10410   // list and pass indirectly on RV32.
10411   bool IsRetIndirect = FI.getReturnInfo().getKind() == ABIArgInfo::Indirect;
10412   if (!IsRetIndirect && RetTy->isScalarType() &&
10413       getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > (2 * XLen)) {
10414     if (RetTy->isComplexType() && FLen) {
10415       QualType EltTy = RetTy->getAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
10416       IsRetIndirect = getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy) > FLen;
10417     } else {
10418       // This is a normal scalar > 2*XLen, such as fp128 on RV32.
10419       IsRetIndirect = true;
10420     }
10421   }
10422 
10423   // We must track the number of GPRs used in order to conform to the RISC-V
10424   // ABI, as integer scalars passed in registers should have signext/zeroext
10425   // when promoted, but are anyext if passed on the stack. As GPR usage is
10426   // different for variadic arguments, we must also track whether we are
10427   // examining a vararg or not.
10428   int ArgGPRsLeft = IsRetIndirect ? NumArgGPRs - 1 : NumArgGPRs;
10429   int ArgFPRsLeft = FLen ? NumArgFPRs : 0;
10430   int NumFixedArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs();
10431 
10432   int ArgNum = 0;
10433   for (auto &ArgInfo : FI.arguments()) {
10434     bool IsFixed = ArgNum < NumFixedArgs;
10435     ArgInfo.info =
10436         classifyArgumentType(ArgInfo.type, IsFixed, ArgGPRsLeft, ArgFPRsLeft);
10437     ArgNum++;
10438   }
10439 }
10440 
10441 // Returns true if the struct is a potential candidate for the floating point
10442 // calling convention. If this function returns true, the caller is
10443 // responsible for checking that if there is only a single field then that
10444 // field is a float.
10445 bool RISCVABIInfo::detectFPCCEligibleStructHelper(QualType Ty, CharUnits CurOff,
10446                                                   llvm::Type *&Field1Ty,
10447                                                   CharUnits &Field1Off,
10448                                                   llvm::Type *&Field2Ty,
10449                                                   CharUnits &Field2Off) const {
10450   bool IsInt = Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
10451   bool IsFloat = Ty->isRealFloatingType();
10452 
10453   if (IsInt || IsFloat) {
10454     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
10455     if (IsInt && Size > XLen)
10456       return false;
10457     // Can't be eligible if larger than the FP registers. Half precision isn't
10458     // currently supported on RISC-V and the ABI hasn't been confirmed, so
10459     // default to the integer ABI in that case.
10460     if (IsFloat && (Size > FLen || Size < 32))
10461       return false;
10462     // Can't be eligible if an integer type was already found (int+int pairs
10463     // are not eligible).
10464     if (IsInt && Field1Ty && Field1Ty->isIntegerTy())
10465       return false;
10466     if (!Field1Ty) {
10467       Field1Ty = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
10468       Field1Off = CurOff;
10469       return true;
10470     }
10471     if (!Field2Ty) {
10472       Field2Ty = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
10473       Field2Off = CurOff;
10474       return true;
10475     }
10476     return false;
10477   }
10478 
10479   if (auto CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
10480     if (Field1Ty)
10481       return false;
10482     QualType EltTy = CTy->getElementType();
10483     if (getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy) > FLen)
10484       return false;
10485     Field1Ty = CGT.ConvertType(EltTy);
10486     Field1Off = CurOff;
10487     assert(CurOff.isZero() && "Unexpected offset for first field");
10488     Field2Ty = Field1Ty;
10489     Field2Off = Field1Off + getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(EltTy);
10490     return true;
10491   }
10492 
10493   if (const ConstantArrayType *ATy = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
10494     uint64_t ArraySize = ATy->getSize().getZExtValue();
10495     QualType EltTy = ATy->getElementType();
10496     CharUnits EltSize = getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(EltTy);
10497     for (uint64_t i = 0; i < ArraySize; ++i) {
10498       bool Ret = detectFPCCEligibleStructHelper(EltTy, CurOff, Field1Ty,
10499                                                 Field1Off, Field2Ty, Field2Off);
10500       if (!Ret)
10501         return false;
10502       CurOff += EltSize;
10503     }
10504     return true;
10505   }
10506 
10507   if (const auto *RTy = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
10508     // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial
10509     // copy constructor are not eligible for the FP calling convention.
10510     if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, CGT.getCXXABI()))
10511       return false;
10512     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
10513       return true;
10514     const RecordDecl *RD = RTy->getDecl();
10515     // Unions aren't eligible unless they're empty (which is caught above).
10516     if (RD->isUnion())
10517       return false;
10518     int ZeroWidthBitFieldCount = 0;
10519     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields()) {
10520       const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
10521       uint64_t FieldOffInBits = Layout.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex());
10522       QualType QTy = FD->getType();
10523       if (FD->isBitField()) {
10524         unsigned BitWidth = FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext());
10525         // Allow a bitfield with a type greater than XLen as long as the
10526         // bitwidth is XLen or less.
10527         if (getContext().getTypeSize(QTy) > XLen && BitWidth <= XLen)
10528           QTy = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(XLen, false);
10529         if (BitWidth == 0) {
10530           ZeroWidthBitFieldCount++;
10531           continue;
10532         }
10533       }
10534 
10535       bool Ret = detectFPCCEligibleStructHelper(
10536           QTy, CurOff + getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(FieldOffInBits),
10537           Field1Ty, Field1Off, Field2Ty, Field2Off);
10538       if (!Ret)
10539         return false;
10540 
10541       // As a quirk of the ABI, zero-width bitfields aren't ignored for fp+fp
10542       // or int+fp structs, but are ignored for a struct with an fp field and
10543       // any number of zero-width bitfields.
10544       if (Field2Ty && ZeroWidthBitFieldCount > 0)
10545         return false;
10546     }
10547     return Field1Ty != nullptr;
10548   }
10549 
10550   return false;
10551 }
10552 
10553 // Determine if a struct is eligible for passing according to the floating
10554 // point calling convention (i.e., when flattened it contains a single fp
10555 // value, fp+fp, or int+fp of appropriate size). If so, NeededArgFPRs and
10556 // NeededArgGPRs are incremented appropriately.
10557 bool RISCVABIInfo::detectFPCCEligibleStruct(QualType Ty, llvm::Type *&Field1Ty,
10558                                             CharUnits &Field1Off,
10559                                             llvm::Type *&Field2Ty,
10560                                             CharUnits &Field2Off,
10561                                             int &NeededArgGPRs,
10562                                             int &NeededArgFPRs) const {
10563   Field1Ty = nullptr;
10564   Field2Ty = nullptr;
10565   NeededArgGPRs = 0;
10566   NeededArgFPRs = 0;
10567   bool IsCandidate = detectFPCCEligibleStructHelper(
10568       Ty, CharUnits::Zero(), Field1Ty, Field1Off, Field2Ty, Field2Off);
10569   // Not really a candidate if we have a single int but no float.
10570   if (Field1Ty && !Field2Ty && !Field1Ty->isFloatingPointTy())
10571     return false;
10572   if (!IsCandidate)
10573     return false;
10574   if (Field1Ty && Field1Ty->isFloatingPointTy())
10575     NeededArgFPRs++;
10576   else if (Field1Ty)
10577     NeededArgGPRs++;
10578   if (Field2Ty && Field2Ty->isFloatingPointTy())
10579     NeededArgFPRs++;
10580   else if (Field2Ty)
10581     NeededArgGPRs++;
10582   return IsCandidate;
10583 }
10584 
10585 // Call getCoerceAndExpand for the two-element flattened struct described by
10586 // Field1Ty, Field1Off, Field2Ty, Field2Off. This method will create an
10587 // appropriate coerceToType and unpaddedCoerceToType.
10588 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::coerceAndExpandFPCCEligibleStruct(
10589     llvm::Type *Field1Ty, CharUnits Field1Off, llvm::Type *Field2Ty,
10590     CharUnits Field2Off) const {
10591   SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> CoerceElts;
10592   SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 2> UnpaddedCoerceElts;
10593   if (!Field1Off.isZero())
10594     CoerceElts.push_back(llvm::ArrayType::get(
10595         llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()), Field1Off.getQuantity()));
10596 
10597   CoerceElts.push_back(Field1Ty);
10598   UnpaddedCoerceElts.push_back(Field1Ty);
10599 
10600   if (!Field2Ty) {
10601     return ABIArgInfo::getCoerceAndExpand(
10602         llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), CoerceElts, !Field1Off.isZero()),
10603         UnpaddedCoerceElts[0]);
10604   }
10605 
10606   CharUnits Field2Align =
10607       CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(Field2Ty));
10608   CharUnits Field1Size =
10609       CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSize(Field1Ty));
10610   CharUnits Field2OffNoPadNoPack = Field1Size.alignTo(Field2Align);
10611 
10612   CharUnits Padding = CharUnits::Zero();
10613   if (Field2Off > Field2OffNoPadNoPack)
10614     Padding = Field2Off - Field2OffNoPadNoPack;
10615   else if (Field2Off != Field2Align && Field2Off > Field1Size)
10616     Padding = Field2Off - Field1Size;
10617 
10618   bool IsPacked = !Field2Off.isMultipleOf(Field2Align);
10619 
10620   if (!Padding.isZero())
10621     CoerceElts.push_back(llvm::ArrayType::get(
10622         llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()), Padding.getQuantity()));
10623 
10624   CoerceElts.push_back(Field2Ty);
10625   UnpaddedCoerceElts.push_back(Field2Ty);
10626 
10627   auto CoerceToType =
10628       llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), CoerceElts, IsPacked);
10629   auto UnpaddedCoerceToType =
10630       llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), UnpaddedCoerceElts, IsPacked);
10631 
10632   return ABIArgInfo::getCoerceAndExpand(CoerceToType, UnpaddedCoerceToType);
10633 }
10634 
10635 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, bool IsFixed,
10636                                               int &ArgGPRsLeft,
10637                                               int &ArgFPRsLeft) const {
10638   assert(ArgGPRsLeft <= NumArgGPRs && "Arg GPR tracking underflow");
10639   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
10640 
10641   // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial
10642   // copy constructor are always passed indirectly.
10643   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
10644     if (ArgGPRsLeft)
10645       ArgGPRsLeft -= 1;
10646     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA ==
10647                                            CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
10648   }
10649 
10650   // Ignore empty structs/unions.
10651   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
10652     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
10653 
10654   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
10655 
10656   // Pass floating point values via FPRs if possible.
10657   if (IsFixed && Ty->isFloatingType() && !Ty->isComplexType() &&
10658       FLen >= Size && ArgFPRsLeft) {
10659     ArgFPRsLeft--;
10660     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
10661   }
10662 
10663   // Complex types for the hard float ABI must be passed direct rather than
10664   // using CoerceAndExpand.
10665   if (IsFixed && Ty->isComplexType() && FLen && ArgFPRsLeft >= 2) {
10666     QualType EltTy = Ty->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
10667     if (getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy) <= FLen) {
10668       ArgFPRsLeft -= 2;
10669       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
10670     }
10671   }
10672 
10673   if (IsFixed && FLen && Ty->isStructureOrClassType()) {
10674     llvm::Type *Field1Ty = nullptr;
10675     llvm::Type *Field2Ty = nullptr;
10676     CharUnits Field1Off = CharUnits::Zero();
10677     CharUnits Field2Off = CharUnits::Zero();
10678     int NeededArgGPRs;
10679     int NeededArgFPRs;
10680     bool IsCandidate =
10681         detectFPCCEligibleStruct(Ty, Field1Ty, Field1Off, Field2Ty, Field2Off,
10682                                  NeededArgGPRs, NeededArgFPRs);
10683     if (IsCandidate && NeededArgGPRs <= ArgGPRsLeft &&
10684         NeededArgFPRs <= ArgFPRsLeft) {
10685       ArgGPRsLeft -= NeededArgGPRs;
10686       ArgFPRsLeft -= NeededArgFPRs;
10687       return coerceAndExpandFPCCEligibleStruct(Field1Ty, Field1Off, Field2Ty,
10688                                                Field2Off);
10689     }
10690   }
10691 
10692   uint64_t NeededAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty);
10693   bool MustUseStack = false;
10694   // Determine the number of GPRs needed to pass the current argument
10695   // according to the ABI. 2*XLen-aligned varargs are passed in "aligned"
10696   // register pairs, so may consume 3 registers.
10697   int NeededArgGPRs = 1;
10698   if (!IsFixed && NeededAlign == 2 * XLen)
10699     NeededArgGPRs = 2 + (ArgGPRsLeft % 2);
10700   else if (Size > XLen && Size <= 2 * XLen)
10701     NeededArgGPRs = 2;
10702 
10703   if (NeededArgGPRs > ArgGPRsLeft) {
10704     MustUseStack = true;
10705     NeededArgGPRs = ArgGPRsLeft;
10706   }
10707 
10708   ArgGPRsLeft -= NeededArgGPRs;
10709 
10710   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !Ty->isVectorType()) {
10711     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
10712     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
10713       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
10714 
10715     // All integral types are promoted to XLen width, unless passed on the
10716     // stack.
10717     if (Size < XLen && Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && !MustUseStack) {
10718       return extendType(Ty);
10719     }
10720 
10721     if (const auto *EIT = Ty->getAs<ExtIntType>()) {
10722       if (EIT->getNumBits() < XLen && !MustUseStack)
10723         return extendType(Ty);
10724       if (EIT->getNumBits() > 128 ||
10725           (!getContext().getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type() &&
10726            EIT->getNumBits() > 64))
10727         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
10728     }
10729 
10730     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
10731   }
10732 
10733   // Aggregates which are <= 2*XLen will be passed in registers if possible,
10734   // so coerce to integers.
10735   if (Size <= 2 * XLen) {
10736     unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty);
10737 
10738     // Use a single XLen int if possible, 2*XLen if 2*XLen alignment is
10739     // required, and a 2-element XLen array if only XLen alignment is required.
10740     if (Size <= XLen) {
10741       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
10742           llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), XLen));
10743     } else if (Alignment == 2 * XLen) {
10744       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
10745           llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 2 * XLen));
10746     } else {
10747       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(
10748           llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), XLen), 2));
10749     }
10750   }
10751   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
10752 }
10753 
10754 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
10755   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
10756     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
10757 
10758   int ArgGPRsLeft = 2;
10759   int ArgFPRsLeft = FLen ? 2 : 0;
10760 
10761   // The rules for return and argument types are the same, so defer to
10762   // classifyArgumentType.
10763   return classifyArgumentType(RetTy, /*IsFixed=*/true, ArgGPRsLeft,
10764                               ArgFPRsLeft);
10765 }
10766 
10767 Address RISCVABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
10768                                 QualType Ty) const {
10769   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(XLen / 8);
10770 
10771   // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes.
10772   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) {
10773     Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize);
10774     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
10775     return Addr;
10776   }
10777 
10778   auto TInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
10779 
10780   // Arguments bigger than 2*Xlen bytes are passed indirectly.
10781   bool IsIndirect = TInfo.Width > 2 * SlotSize;
10782 
10783   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TInfo,
10784                           SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign=*/true);
10785 }
10786 
10787 ABIArgInfo RISCVABIInfo::extendType(QualType Ty) const {
10788   int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
10789   // RV64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended.
10790   if (XLen == 64 && Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32)
10791     return ABIArgInfo::getSignExtend(Ty);
10792   return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
10793 }
10794 
10795 namespace {
10796 class RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
10797 public:
10798   RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, unsigned XLen,
10799                          unsigned FLen)
10800       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<RISCVABIInfo>(CGT, XLen, FLen)) {}
10801 
10802   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
10803                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
10804     const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
10805     if (!FD) return;
10806 
10807     const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<RISCVInterruptAttr>();
10808     if (!Attr)
10809       return;
10810 
10811     const char *Kind;
10812     switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) {
10813     case RISCVInterruptAttr::user: Kind = "user"; break;
10814     case RISCVInterruptAttr::supervisor: Kind = "supervisor"; break;
10815     case RISCVInterruptAttr::machine: Kind = "machine"; break;
10816     }
10817 
10818     auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
10819 
10820     Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind);
10821   }
10822 };
10823 } // namespace
10824 
10825 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10826 // VE ABI Implementation.
10827 //
10828 namespace {
10829 class VEABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
10830 public:
10831   VEABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
10832 
10833 private:
10834   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
10835   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
10836   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
10837 };
10838 } // end anonymous namespace
10839 
10840 ABIArgInfo VEABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const {
10841   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
10842     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
10843   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
10844   if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType())
10845     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
10846   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty);
10847 }
10848 
10849 ABIArgInfo VEABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
10850   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
10851     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
10852   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
10853   if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType())
10854     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend(Ty);
10855   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
10856 }
10857 
10858 void VEABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
10859   FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
10860   for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
10861     Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
10862 }
10863 
10864 namespace {
10865 class VETargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
10866 public:
10867   VETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
10868       : TargetCodeGenInfo(std::make_unique<VEABIInfo>(CGT)) {}
10869   // VE ABI requires the arguments of variadic and prototype-less functions
10870   // are passed in both registers and memory.
10871   bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args,
10872                              const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override {
10873     return true;
10874   }
10875 };
10876 } // end anonymous namespace
10877 
10878 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10879 // Driver code
10880 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
10881 
10882 bool CodeGenModule::supportsCOMDAT() const {
10883   return getTriple().supportsCOMDAT();
10884 }
10885 
10886 const TargetCodeGenInfo &CodeGenModule::getTargetCodeGenInfo() {
10887   if (TheTargetCodeGenInfo)
10888     return *TheTargetCodeGenInfo;
10889 
10890   // Helper to set the unique_ptr while still keeping the return value.
10891   auto SetCGInfo = [&](TargetCodeGenInfo *P) -> const TargetCodeGenInfo & {
10892     this->TheTargetCodeGenInfo.reset(P);
10893     return *P;
10894   };
10895 
10896   const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple();
10897   switch (Triple.getArch()) {
10898   default:
10899     return SetCGInfo(new DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
10900 
10901   case llvm::Triple::le32:
10902     return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
10903   case llvm::Triple::mips:
10904   case llvm::Triple::mipsel:
10905     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::NaCl)
10906       return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
10907     return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, true));
10908 
10909   case llvm::Triple::mips64:
10910   case llvm::Triple::mips64el:
10911     return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, false));
10912 
10913   case llvm::Triple::avr:
10914     return SetCGInfo(new AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
10915 
10916   case llvm::Triple::aarch64:
10917   case llvm::Triple::aarch64_32:
10918   case llvm::Triple::aarch64_be: {
10919     AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS;
10920     if (getTarget().getABI() == "darwinpcs")
10921       Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::DarwinPCS;
10922     else if (Triple.isOSWindows())
10923       return SetCGInfo(
10924           new WindowsAArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AArch64ABIInfo::Win64));
10925 
10926     return SetCGInfo(new AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind));
10927   }
10928 
10929   case llvm::Triple::wasm32:
10930   case llvm::Triple::wasm64: {
10931     WebAssemblyABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = WebAssemblyABIInfo::MVP;
10932     if (getTarget().getABI() == "experimental-mv")
10933       Kind = WebAssemblyABIInfo::ExperimentalMV;
10934     return SetCGInfo(new WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind));
10935   }
10936 
10937   case llvm::Triple::arm:
10938   case llvm::Triple::armeb:
10939   case llvm::Triple::thumb:
10940   case llvm::Triple::thumbeb: {
10941     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) {
10942       return SetCGInfo(
10943           new WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP));
10944     }
10945 
10946     ARMABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS;
10947     StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI();
10948     if (ABIStr == "apcs-gnu")
10949       Kind = ARMABIInfo::APCS;
10950     else if (ABIStr == "aapcs16")
10951       Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP;
10952     else if (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "hard" ||
10953              (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI != "soft" &&
10954               (Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF ||
10955                Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF ||
10956                Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::EABIHF)))
10957       Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP;
10958 
10959     return SetCGInfo(new ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind));
10960   }
10961 
10962   case llvm::Triple::ppc: {
10963     if (Triple.isOSAIX())
10964       return SetCGInfo(new AIXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, /*Is64Bit*/ false));
10965 
10966     bool IsSoftFloat =
10967         CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft" || getTarget().hasFeature("spe");
10968     bool RetSmallStructInRegABI =
10969         PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts);
10970     return SetCGInfo(
10971         new PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, IsSoftFloat, RetSmallStructInRegABI));
10972   }
10973   case llvm::Triple::ppc64:
10974     if (Triple.isOSAIX())
10975       return SetCGInfo(new AIXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, /*Is64Bit*/ true));
10976 
10977     if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF()) {
10978       PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1;
10979       if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv2")
10980         Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2;
10981       bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx";
10982       bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft";
10983 
10984       return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX,
10985                                                         IsSoftFloat));
10986     }
10987     return SetCGInfo(new PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
10988   case llvm::Triple::ppc64le: {
10989     assert(Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && "PPC64 LE non-ELF not supported!");
10990     PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2;
10991     if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1" || getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx")
10992       Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1;
10993     bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx";
10994     bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft";
10995 
10996     return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX,
10997                                                       IsSoftFloat));
10998   }
10999 
11000   case llvm::Triple::nvptx:
11001   case llvm::Triple::nvptx64:
11002     return SetCGInfo(new NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11003 
11004   case llvm::Triple::msp430:
11005     return SetCGInfo(new MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11006 
11007   case llvm::Triple::riscv32:
11008   case llvm::Triple::riscv64: {
11009     StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI();
11010     unsigned XLen = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0);
11011     unsigned ABIFLen = 0;
11012     if (ABIStr.endswith("f"))
11013       ABIFLen = 32;
11014     else if (ABIStr.endswith("d"))
11015       ABIFLen = 64;
11016     return SetCGInfo(new RISCVTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, XLen, ABIFLen));
11017   }
11018 
11019   case llvm::Triple::systemz: {
11020     bool SoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft";
11021     bool HasVector = !SoftFloat && getTarget().getABI() == "vector";
11022     return SetCGInfo(new SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, HasVector, SoftFloat));
11023   }
11024 
11025   case llvm::Triple::tce:
11026   case llvm::Triple::tcele:
11027     return SetCGInfo(new TCETargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11028 
11029   case llvm::Triple::x86: {
11030     bool IsDarwinVectorABI = Triple.isOSDarwin();
11031     bool RetSmallStructInRegABI =
11032         X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts);
11033     bool IsWin32FloatStructABI = Triple.isOSWindows() && !Triple.isOSCygMing();
11034 
11035     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) {
11036       return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(
11037           Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
11038           IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters));
11039     } else {
11040       return SetCGInfo(new X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(
11041           Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
11042           IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters,
11043           CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"));
11044     }
11045   }
11046 
11047   case llvm::Triple::x86_64: {
11048     StringRef ABI = getTarget().getABI();
11049     X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel =
11050         (ABI == "avx512"
11051              ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX512
11052              : ABI == "avx" ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX : X86AVXABILevel::None);
11053 
11054     switch (Triple.getOS()) {
11055     case llvm::Triple::Win32:
11056       return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel));
11057     default:
11058       return SetCGInfo(new X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel));
11059     }
11060   }
11061   case llvm::Triple::hexagon:
11062     return SetCGInfo(new HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11063   case llvm::Triple::lanai:
11064     return SetCGInfo(new LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11065   case llvm::Triple::r600:
11066     return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11067   case llvm::Triple::amdgcn:
11068     return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11069   case llvm::Triple::sparc:
11070     return SetCGInfo(new SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11071   case llvm::Triple::sparcv9:
11072     return SetCGInfo(new SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11073   case llvm::Triple::xcore:
11074     return SetCGInfo(new XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11075   case llvm::Triple::arc:
11076     return SetCGInfo(new ARCTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11077   case llvm::Triple::spir:
11078   case llvm::Triple::spir64:
11079     return SetCGInfo(new SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11080   case llvm::Triple::ve:
11081     return SetCGInfo(new VETargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
11082   }
11083 }
11084 
11085 /// Create an OpenCL kernel for an enqueued block.
11086 ///
11087 /// The kernel has the same function type as the block invoke function. Its
11088 /// name is the name of the block invoke function postfixed with "_kernel".
11089 /// It simply calls the block invoke function then returns.
11090 llvm::Function *
11091 TargetCodeGenInfo::createEnqueuedBlockKernel(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
11092                                              llvm::Function *Invoke,
11093                                              llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const {
11094   auto *InvokeFT = Invoke->getFunctionType();
11095   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 2> ArgTys;
11096   for (auto &P : InvokeFT->params())
11097     ArgTys.push_back(P);
11098   auto &C = CGF.getLLVMContext();
11099   std::string Name = Invoke->getName().str() + "_kernel";
11100   auto *FT = llvm::FunctionType::get(llvm::Type::getVoidTy(C), ArgTys, false);
11101   auto *F = llvm::Function::Create(FT, llvm::GlobalValue::InternalLinkage, Name,
11102                                    &CGF.CGM.getModule());
11103   auto IP = CGF.Builder.saveIP();
11104   auto *BB = llvm::BasicBlock::Create(C, "entry", F);
11105   auto &Builder = CGF.Builder;
11106   Builder.SetInsertPoint(BB);
11107   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Value *, 2> Args;
11108   for (auto &A : F->args())
11109     Args.push_back(&A);
11110   Builder.CreateCall(Invoke, Args);
11111   Builder.CreateRetVoid();
11112   Builder.restoreIP(IP);
11113   return F;
11114 }
11115 
11116 /// Create an OpenCL kernel for an enqueued block.
11117 ///
11118 /// The type of the first argument (the block literal) is the struct type
11119 /// of the block literal instead of a pointer type. The first argument
11120 /// (block literal) is passed directly by value to the kernel. The kernel
11121 /// allocates the same type of struct on stack and stores the block literal
11122 /// to it and passes its pointer to the block invoke function. The kernel
11123 /// has "enqueued-block" function attribute and kernel argument metadata.
11124 llvm::Function *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::createEnqueuedBlockKernel(
11125     CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Function *Invoke,
11126     llvm::Value *BlockLiteral) const {
11127   auto &Builder = CGF.Builder;
11128   auto &C = CGF.getLLVMContext();
11129 
11130   auto *BlockTy = BlockLiteral->getType()->getPointerElementType();
11131   auto *InvokeFT = Invoke->getFunctionType();
11132   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 2> ArgTys;
11133   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> AddressQuals;
11134   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> AccessQuals;
11135   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgTypeNames;
11136   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgBaseTypeNames;
11137   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgTypeQuals;
11138   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 8> ArgNames;
11139 
11140   ArgTys.push_back(BlockTy);
11141   ArgTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "__block_literal"));
11142   AddressQuals.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(Builder.getInt32(0)));
11143   ArgBaseTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "__block_literal"));
11144   ArgTypeQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, ""));
11145   AccessQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "none"));
11146   ArgNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "block_literal"));
11147   for (unsigned I = 1, E = InvokeFT->getNumParams(); I < E; ++I) {
11148     ArgTys.push_back(InvokeFT->getParamType(I));
11149     ArgTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "void*"));
11150     AddressQuals.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(Builder.getInt32(3)));
11151     AccessQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "none"));
11152     ArgBaseTypeNames.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, "void*"));
11153     ArgTypeQuals.push_back(llvm::MDString::get(C, ""));
11154     ArgNames.push_back(
11155         llvm::MDString::get(C, (Twine("local_arg") + Twine(I)).str()));
11156   }
11157   std::string Name = Invoke->getName().str() + "_kernel";
11158   auto *FT = llvm::FunctionType::get(llvm::Type::getVoidTy(C), ArgTys, false);
11159   auto *F = llvm::Function::Create(FT, llvm::GlobalValue::InternalLinkage, Name,
11160                                    &CGF.CGM.getModule());
11161   F->addFnAttr("enqueued-block");
11162   auto IP = CGF.Builder.saveIP();
11163   auto *BB = llvm::BasicBlock::Create(C, "entry", F);
11164   Builder.SetInsertPoint(BB);
11165   const auto BlockAlign = CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().getPrefTypeAlign(BlockTy);
11166   auto *BlockPtr = Builder.CreateAlloca(BlockTy, nullptr);
11167   BlockPtr->setAlignment(BlockAlign);
11168   Builder.CreateAlignedStore(F->arg_begin(), BlockPtr, BlockAlign);
11169   auto *Cast = Builder.CreatePointerCast(BlockPtr, InvokeFT->getParamType(0));
11170   llvm::SmallVector<llvm::Value *, 2> Args;
11171   Args.push_back(Cast);
11172   for (auto I = F->arg_begin() + 1, E = F->arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
11173     Args.push_back(I);
11174   Builder.CreateCall(Invoke, Args);
11175   Builder.CreateRetVoid();
11176   Builder.restoreIP(IP);
11177 
11178   F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_addr_space", llvm::MDNode::get(C, AddressQuals));
11179   F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_access_qual", llvm::MDNode::get(C, AccessQuals));
11180   F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_type", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgTypeNames));
11181   F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_base_type",
11182                  llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgBaseTypeNames));
11183   F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_type_qual", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgTypeQuals));
11184   if (CGF.CGM.getCodeGenOpts().EmitOpenCLArgMetadata)
11185     F->setMetadata("kernel_arg_name", llvm::MDNode::get(C, ArgNames));
11186 
11187   return F;
11188 }
11189